1
0
Fork 0
alistair23-linux/drivers/net/ethernet/ti/netcp_ethss.c

3886 lines
106 KiB
C
Raw Normal View History

// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0
/*
* Keystone GBE and XGBE subsystem code
*
* Copyright (C) 2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
* Authors: Sandeep Nair <sandeep_n@ti.com>
* Sandeep Paulraj <s-paulraj@ti.com>
* Cyril Chemparathy <cyril@ti.com>
* Santosh Shilimkar <santosh.shilimkar@ti.com>
* Wingman Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com>
*/
#include <linux/io.h>
#include <linux/module.h>
#include <linux/of_mdio.h>
#include <linux/of_net.h>
#include <linux/of_address.h>
#include <linux/if_vlan.h>
#include <linux/ptp_classify.h>
#include <linux/net_tstamp.h>
#include <linux/ethtool.h>
#include "cpsw.h"
#include "cpsw_ale.h"
#include "netcp.h"
#include "cpts.h"
#define NETCP_DRIVER_NAME "TI KeyStone Ethernet Driver"
#define NETCP_DRIVER_VERSION "v1.0"
#define GBE_IDENT(reg) ((reg >> 16) & 0xffff)
#define GBE_MAJOR_VERSION(reg) (reg >> 8 & 0x7)
#define GBE_MINOR_VERSION(reg) (reg & 0xff)
#define GBE_RTL_VERSION(reg) ((reg >> 11) & 0x1f)
/* 1G Ethernet SS defines */
#define GBE_MODULE_NAME "netcp-gbe"
#define GBE_SS_VERSION_14 0x4ed2
#define GBE_SS_REG_INDEX 0
#define GBE_SGMII34_REG_INDEX 1
#define GBE_SM_REG_INDEX 2
/* offset relative to base of GBE_SS_REG_INDEX */
#define GBE13_SGMII_MODULE_OFFSET 0x100
/* offset relative to base of GBE_SM_REG_INDEX */
#define GBE13_HOST_PORT_OFFSET 0x34
#define GBE13_SLAVE_PORT_OFFSET 0x60
#define GBE13_EMAC_OFFSET 0x100
#define GBE13_SLAVE_PORT2_OFFSET 0x200
#define GBE13_HW_STATS_OFFSET 0x300
#define GBE13_CPTS_OFFSET 0x500
#define GBE13_ALE_OFFSET 0x600
#define GBE13_HOST_PORT_NUM 0
#define GBE13_NUM_ALE_ENTRIES 1024
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* 1G Ethernet NU SS defines */
#define GBENU_MODULE_NAME "netcp-gbenu"
#define GBE_SS_ID_NU 0x4ee6
#define GBE_SS_ID_2U 0x4ee8
#define IS_SS_ID_MU(d) \
((GBE_IDENT((d)->ss_version) == GBE_SS_ID_NU) || \
(GBE_IDENT((d)->ss_version) == GBE_SS_ID_2U))
#define IS_SS_ID_NU(d) \
(GBE_IDENT((d)->ss_version) == GBE_SS_ID_NU)
#define IS_SS_ID_VER_14(d) \
(GBE_IDENT((d)->ss_version) == GBE_SS_VERSION_14)
#define IS_SS_ID_2U(d) \
(GBE_IDENT((d)->ss_version) == GBE_SS_ID_2U)
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBENU_SS_REG_INDEX 0
#define GBENU_SM_REG_INDEX 1
#define GBENU_SGMII_MODULE_OFFSET 0x100
#define GBENU_HOST_PORT_OFFSET 0x1000
#define GBENU_SLAVE_PORT_OFFSET 0x2000
#define GBENU_EMAC_OFFSET 0x2330
#define GBENU_HW_STATS_OFFSET 0x1a000
#define GBENU_CPTS_OFFSET 0x1d000
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBENU_ALE_OFFSET 0x1e000
#define GBENU_HOST_PORT_NUM 0
#define GBENU_SGMII_MODULE_SIZE 0x100
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* 10G Ethernet SS defines */
#define XGBE_MODULE_NAME "netcp-xgbe"
#define XGBE_SS_VERSION_10 0x4ee4
#define XGBE_SS_REG_INDEX 0
#define XGBE_SM_REG_INDEX 1
#define XGBE_SERDES_REG_INDEX 2
/* offset relative to base of XGBE_SS_REG_INDEX */
#define XGBE10_SGMII_MODULE_OFFSET 0x100
#define IS_SS_ID_XGBE(d) ((d)->ss_version == XGBE_SS_VERSION_10)
/* offset relative to base of XGBE_SM_REG_INDEX */
#define XGBE10_HOST_PORT_OFFSET 0x34
#define XGBE10_SLAVE_PORT_OFFSET 0x64
#define XGBE10_EMAC_OFFSET 0x400
#define XGBE10_CPTS_OFFSET 0x600
#define XGBE10_ALE_OFFSET 0x700
#define XGBE10_HW_STATS_OFFSET 0x800
#define XGBE10_HOST_PORT_NUM 0
#define XGBE10_NUM_ALE_ENTRIES 2048
#define GBE_TIMER_INTERVAL (HZ / 2)
/* Soft reset register values */
#define SOFT_RESET_MASK BIT(0)
#define SOFT_RESET BIT(0)
#define DEVICE_EMACSL_RESET_POLL_COUNT 100
#define GMACSL_RET_WARN_RESET_INCOMPLETE -2
#define MACSL_RX_ENABLE_CSF BIT(23)
#define MACSL_ENABLE_EXT_CTL BIT(18)
#define MACSL_XGMII_ENABLE BIT(13)
#define MACSL_XGIG_MODE BIT(8)
#define MACSL_GIG_MODE BIT(7)
#define MACSL_GMII_ENABLE BIT(5)
#define MACSL_FULLDUPLEX BIT(0)
#define GBE_CTL_P0_ENABLE BIT(2)
#define ETH_SW_CTL_P0_TX_CRC_REMOVE BIT(13)
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBE13_REG_VAL_STAT_ENABLE_ALL 0xff
#define XGBE_REG_VAL_STAT_ENABLE_ALL 0xf
#define GBE_STATS_CD_SEL BIT(28)
#define GBE_PORT_MASK(x) (BIT(x) - 1)
#define GBE_MASK_NO_PORTS 0
#define GBE_DEF_1G_MAC_CONTROL \
(MACSL_GIG_MODE | MACSL_GMII_ENABLE | \
MACSL_ENABLE_EXT_CTL | MACSL_RX_ENABLE_CSF)
#define GBE_DEF_10G_MAC_CONTROL \
(MACSL_XGIG_MODE | MACSL_XGMII_ENABLE | \
MACSL_ENABLE_EXT_CTL | MACSL_RX_ENABLE_CSF)
#define GBE_STATSA_MODULE 0
#define GBE_STATSB_MODULE 1
#define GBE_STATSC_MODULE 2
#define GBE_STATSD_MODULE 3
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBENU_STATS0_MODULE 0
#define GBENU_STATS1_MODULE 1
#define GBENU_STATS2_MODULE 2
#define GBENU_STATS3_MODULE 3
#define GBENU_STATS4_MODULE 4
#define GBENU_STATS5_MODULE 5
#define GBENU_STATS6_MODULE 6
#define GBENU_STATS7_MODULE 7
#define GBENU_STATS8_MODULE 8
#define XGBE_STATS0_MODULE 0
#define XGBE_STATS1_MODULE 1
#define XGBE_STATS2_MODULE 2
/* s: 0-based slave_port */
#define SGMII_BASE(d, s) \
(((s) < 2) ? (d)->sgmii_port_regs : (d)->sgmii_port34_regs)
#define GBE_TX_QUEUE 648
#define GBE_TXHOOK_ORDER 0
#define GBE_RXHOOK_ORDER 0
#define GBE_DEFAULT_ALE_AGEOUT 30
#define SLAVE_LINK_IS_XGMII(s) ((s)->link_interface >= XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY)
#define SLAVE_LINK_IS_RGMII(s) \
(((s)->link_interface >= RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) && \
((s)->link_interface <= RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY_NO_MDIO))
#define SLAVE_LINK_IS_SGMII(s) \
((s)->link_interface <= SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY_NO_MDIO)
#define NETCP_LINK_STATE_INVALID -1
#define GBE_SET_REG_OFS(p, rb, rn) p->rb##_ofs.rn = \
offsetof(struct gbe##_##rb, rn)
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(p, rb, rn) p->rb##_ofs.rn = \
offsetof(struct gbenu##_##rb, rn)
#define XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(p, rb, rn) p->rb##_ofs.rn = \
offsetof(struct xgbe##_##rb, rn)
#define GBE_REG_ADDR(p, rb, rn) (p->rb + p->rb##_ofs.rn)
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define HOST_TX_PRI_MAP_DEFAULT 0x00000000
#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_TI_CPTS)
/* Px_TS_CTL register fields */
#define TS_RX_ANX_F_EN BIT(0)
#define TS_RX_VLAN_LT1_EN BIT(1)
#define TS_RX_VLAN_LT2_EN BIT(2)
#define TS_RX_ANX_D_EN BIT(3)
#define TS_TX_ANX_F_EN BIT(4)
#define TS_TX_VLAN_LT1_EN BIT(5)
#define TS_TX_VLAN_LT2_EN BIT(6)
#define TS_TX_ANX_D_EN BIT(7)
#define TS_LT2_EN BIT(8)
#define TS_RX_ANX_E_EN BIT(9)
#define TS_TX_ANX_E_EN BIT(10)
#define TS_MSG_TYPE_EN_SHIFT 16
#define TS_MSG_TYPE_EN_MASK 0xffff
/* Px_TS_SEQ_LTYPE register fields */
#define TS_SEQ_ID_OFS_SHIFT 16
#define TS_SEQ_ID_OFS_MASK 0x3f
/* Px_TS_CTL_LTYPE2 register fields */
#define TS_107 BIT(16)
#define TS_129 BIT(17)
#define TS_130 BIT(18)
#define TS_131 BIT(19)
#define TS_132 BIT(20)
#define TS_319 BIT(21)
#define TS_320 BIT(22)
#define TS_TTL_NONZERO BIT(23)
#define TS_UNI_EN BIT(24)
#define TS_UNI_EN_SHIFT 24
#define TS_TX_ANX_ALL_EN \
(TS_TX_ANX_D_EN | TS_TX_ANX_E_EN | TS_TX_ANX_F_EN)
#define TS_RX_ANX_ALL_EN \
(TS_RX_ANX_D_EN | TS_RX_ANX_E_EN | TS_RX_ANX_F_EN)
#define TS_CTL_DST_PORT TS_319
#define TS_CTL_DST_PORT_SHIFT 21
#define TS_CTL_MADDR_ALL \
(TS_107 | TS_129 | TS_130 | TS_131 | TS_132)
#define TS_CTL_MADDR_SHIFT 16
/* The PTP event messages - Sync, Delay_Req, Pdelay_Req, and Pdelay_Resp. */
#define EVENT_MSG_BITS (BIT(0) | BIT(1) | BIT(2) | BIT(3))
#endif /* CONFIG_TI_CPTS */
struct xgbe_ss_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 synce_count;
u32 synce_mux;
u32 control;
};
struct xgbe_switch_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 control;
u32 emcontrol;
u32 stat_port_en;
u32 ptype;
u32 soft_idle;
u32 thru_rate;
u32 gap_thresh;
u32 tx_start_wds;
u32 flow_control;
u32 cppi_thresh;
};
struct xgbe_port_regs {
u32 blk_cnt;
u32 port_vlan;
u32 tx_pri_map;
u32 sa_lo;
u32 sa_hi;
u32 ts_ctl;
u32 ts_seq_ltype;
u32 ts_vlan;
u32 ts_ctl_ltype2;
u32 ts_ctl2;
u32 control;
};
struct xgbe_host_port_regs {
u32 blk_cnt;
u32 port_vlan;
u32 tx_pri_map;
u32 src_id;
u32 rx_pri_map;
u32 rx_maxlen;
};
struct xgbe_emac_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 mac_control;
u32 mac_status;
u32 soft_reset;
u32 rx_maxlen;
u32 __reserved_0;
u32 rx_pause;
u32 tx_pause;
u32 em_control;
u32 __reserved_1;
u32 tx_gap;
u32 rsvd[4];
};
struct xgbe_host_hw_stats {
u32 rx_good_frames;
u32 rx_broadcast_frames;
u32 rx_multicast_frames;
u32 __rsvd_0[3];
u32 rx_oversized_frames;
u32 __rsvd_1;
u32 rx_undersized_frames;
u32 __rsvd_2;
u32 overrun_type4;
u32 overrun_type5;
u32 rx_bytes;
u32 tx_good_frames;
u32 tx_broadcast_frames;
u32 tx_multicast_frames;
u32 __rsvd_3[9];
u32 tx_bytes;
u32 tx_64byte_frames;
u32 tx_65_to_127byte_frames;
u32 tx_128_to_255byte_frames;
u32 tx_256_to_511byte_frames;
u32 tx_512_to_1023byte_frames;
u32 tx_1024byte_frames;
u32 net_bytes;
u32 rx_sof_overruns;
u32 rx_mof_overruns;
u32 rx_dma_overruns;
};
struct xgbe_hw_stats {
u32 rx_good_frames;
u32 rx_broadcast_frames;
u32 rx_multicast_frames;
u32 rx_pause_frames;
u32 rx_crc_errors;
u32 rx_align_code_errors;
u32 rx_oversized_frames;
u32 rx_jabber_frames;
u32 rx_undersized_frames;
u32 rx_fragments;
u32 overrun_type4;
u32 overrun_type5;
u32 rx_bytes;
u32 tx_good_frames;
u32 tx_broadcast_frames;
u32 tx_multicast_frames;
u32 tx_pause_frames;
u32 tx_deferred_frames;
u32 tx_collision_frames;
u32 tx_single_coll_frames;
u32 tx_mult_coll_frames;
u32 tx_excessive_collisions;
u32 tx_late_collisions;
u32 tx_underrun;
u32 tx_carrier_sense_errors;
u32 tx_bytes;
u32 tx_64byte_frames;
u32 tx_65_to_127byte_frames;
u32 tx_128_to_255byte_frames;
u32 tx_256_to_511byte_frames;
u32 tx_512_to_1023byte_frames;
u32 tx_1024byte_frames;
u32 net_bytes;
u32 rx_sof_overruns;
u32 rx_mof_overruns;
u32 rx_dma_overruns;
};
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
struct gbenu_ss_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 synce_count; /* NU */
u32 synce_mux; /* NU */
u32 control; /* 2U */
u32 __rsvd_0[2]; /* 2U */
u32 rgmii_status; /* 2U */
u32 ss_status; /* 2U */
};
struct gbenu_switch_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 control;
u32 __rsvd_0[2];
u32 emcontrol;
u32 stat_port_en;
u32 ptype; /* NU */
u32 soft_idle;
u32 thru_rate; /* NU */
u32 gap_thresh; /* NU */
u32 tx_start_wds; /* NU */
u32 eee_prescale; /* 2U */
u32 tx_g_oflow_thresh_set; /* NU */
u32 tx_g_oflow_thresh_clr; /* NU */
u32 tx_g_buf_thresh_set_l; /* NU */
u32 tx_g_buf_thresh_set_h; /* NU */
u32 tx_g_buf_thresh_clr_l; /* NU */
u32 tx_g_buf_thresh_clr_h; /* NU */
};
struct gbenu_port_regs {
u32 __rsvd_0;
u32 control;
u32 max_blks; /* 2U */
u32 mem_align1;
u32 blk_cnt;
u32 port_vlan;
u32 tx_pri_map; /* NU */
u32 pri_ctl; /* 2U */
u32 rx_pri_map;
u32 rx_maxlen;
u32 tx_blks_pri; /* NU */
u32 __rsvd_1;
u32 idle2lpi; /* 2U */
u32 lpi2idle; /* 2U */
u32 eee_status; /* 2U */
u32 __rsvd_2;
u32 __rsvd_3[176]; /* NU: more to add */
u32 __rsvd_4[2];
u32 sa_lo;
u32 sa_hi;
u32 ts_ctl;
u32 ts_seq_ltype;
u32 ts_vlan;
u32 ts_ctl_ltype2;
u32 ts_ctl2;
};
struct gbenu_host_port_regs {
u32 __rsvd_0;
u32 control;
u32 flow_id_offset; /* 2U */
u32 __rsvd_1;
u32 blk_cnt;
u32 port_vlan;
u32 tx_pri_map; /* NU */
u32 pri_ctl;
u32 rx_pri_map;
u32 rx_maxlen;
u32 tx_blks_pri; /* NU */
u32 __rsvd_2;
u32 idle2lpi; /* 2U */
u32 lpi2wake; /* 2U */
u32 eee_status; /* 2U */
u32 __rsvd_3;
u32 __rsvd_4[184]; /* NU */
u32 host_blks_pri; /* NU */
};
struct gbenu_emac_regs {
u32 mac_control;
u32 mac_status;
u32 soft_reset;
u32 boff_test;
u32 rx_pause;
u32 __rsvd_0[11]; /* NU */
u32 tx_pause;
u32 __rsvd_1[11]; /* NU */
u32 em_control;
u32 tx_gap;
};
/* Some hw stat regs are applicable to slave port only.
* This is handled by gbenu_et_stats struct. Also some
* are for SS version NU and some are for 2U.
*/
struct gbenu_hw_stats {
u32 rx_good_frames;
u32 rx_broadcast_frames;
u32 rx_multicast_frames;
u32 rx_pause_frames; /* slave */
u32 rx_crc_errors;
u32 rx_align_code_errors; /* slave */
u32 rx_oversized_frames;
u32 rx_jabber_frames; /* slave */
u32 rx_undersized_frames;
u32 rx_fragments; /* slave */
u32 ale_drop;
u32 ale_overrun_drop;
u32 rx_bytes;
u32 tx_good_frames;
u32 tx_broadcast_frames;
u32 tx_multicast_frames;
u32 tx_pause_frames; /* slave */
u32 tx_deferred_frames; /* slave */
u32 tx_collision_frames; /* slave */
u32 tx_single_coll_frames; /* slave */
u32 tx_mult_coll_frames; /* slave */
u32 tx_excessive_collisions; /* slave */
u32 tx_late_collisions; /* slave */
u32 rx_ipg_error; /* slave 10G only */
u32 tx_carrier_sense_errors; /* slave */
u32 tx_bytes;
u32 tx_64B_frames;
u32 tx_65_to_127B_frames;
u32 tx_128_to_255B_frames;
u32 tx_256_to_511B_frames;
u32 tx_512_to_1023B_frames;
u32 tx_1024B_frames;
u32 net_bytes;
u32 rx_bottom_fifo_drop;
u32 rx_port_mask_drop;
u32 rx_top_fifo_drop;
u32 ale_rate_limit_drop;
u32 ale_vid_ingress_drop;
u32 ale_da_eq_sa_drop;
u32 __rsvd_0[3];
u32 ale_unknown_ucast;
u32 ale_unknown_ucast_bytes;
u32 ale_unknown_mcast;
u32 ale_unknown_mcast_bytes;
u32 ale_unknown_bcast;
u32 ale_unknown_bcast_bytes;
u32 ale_pol_match;
u32 ale_pol_match_red; /* NU */
u32 ale_pol_match_yellow; /* NU */
u32 __rsvd_1[44];
u32 tx_mem_protect_err;
/* following NU only */
u32 tx_pri0;
u32 tx_pri1;
u32 tx_pri2;
u32 tx_pri3;
u32 tx_pri4;
u32 tx_pri5;
u32 tx_pri6;
u32 tx_pri7;
u32 tx_pri0_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri1_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri2_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri3_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri4_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri5_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri6_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri7_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri0_drop;
u32 tx_pri1_drop;
u32 tx_pri2_drop;
u32 tx_pri3_drop;
u32 tx_pri4_drop;
u32 tx_pri5_drop;
u32 tx_pri6_drop;
u32 tx_pri7_drop;
u32 tx_pri0_drop_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri1_drop_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri2_drop_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri3_drop_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri4_drop_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri5_drop_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri6_drop_bcnt;
u32 tx_pri7_drop_bcnt;
};
#define GBENU_HW_STATS_REG_MAP_SZ 0x200
struct gbe_ss_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 synce_count;
u32 synce_mux;
};
struct gbe_ss_regs_ofs {
u16 id_ver;
u16 control;
u16 rgmii_status; /* 2U */
};
struct gbe_switch_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 control;
u32 soft_reset;
u32 stat_port_en;
u32 ptype;
u32 soft_idle;
u32 thru_rate;
u32 gap_thresh;
u32 tx_start_wds;
u32 flow_control;
};
struct gbe_switch_regs_ofs {
u16 id_ver;
u16 control;
u16 soft_reset;
u16 emcontrol;
u16 stat_port_en;
u16 ptype;
u16 flow_control;
};
struct gbe_port_regs {
u32 max_blks;
u32 blk_cnt;
u32 port_vlan;
u32 tx_pri_map;
u32 sa_lo;
u32 sa_hi;
u32 ts_ctl;
u32 ts_seq_ltype;
u32 ts_vlan;
u32 ts_ctl_ltype2;
u32 ts_ctl2;
};
struct gbe_port_regs_ofs {
u16 port_vlan;
u16 tx_pri_map;
u16 rx_pri_map;
u16 sa_lo;
u16 sa_hi;
u16 ts_ctl;
u16 ts_seq_ltype;
u16 ts_vlan;
u16 ts_ctl_ltype2;
u16 ts_ctl2;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
u16 rx_maxlen; /* 2U, NU */
};
struct gbe_host_port_regs {
u32 src_id;
u32 port_vlan;
u32 rx_pri_map;
u32 rx_maxlen;
};
struct gbe_host_port_regs_ofs {
u16 port_vlan;
u16 tx_pri_map;
u16 rx_maxlen;
};
struct gbe_emac_regs {
u32 id_ver;
u32 mac_control;
u32 mac_status;
u32 soft_reset;
u32 rx_maxlen;
u32 __reserved_0;
u32 rx_pause;
u32 tx_pause;
u32 __reserved_1;
u32 rx_pri_map;
u32 rsvd[6];
};
struct gbe_emac_regs_ofs {
u16 mac_control;
u16 soft_reset;
u16 rx_maxlen;
};
struct gbe_hw_stats {
u32 rx_good_frames;
u32 rx_broadcast_frames;
u32 rx_multicast_frames;
u32 rx_pause_frames;
u32 rx_crc_errors;
u32 rx_align_code_errors;
u32 rx_oversized_frames;
u32 rx_jabber_frames;
u32 rx_undersized_frames;
u32 rx_fragments;
u32 __pad_0[2];
u32 rx_bytes;
u32 tx_good_frames;
u32 tx_broadcast_frames;
u32 tx_multicast_frames;
u32 tx_pause_frames;
u32 tx_deferred_frames;
u32 tx_collision_frames;
u32 tx_single_coll_frames;
u32 tx_mult_coll_frames;
u32 tx_excessive_collisions;
u32 tx_late_collisions;
u32 tx_underrun;
u32 tx_carrier_sense_errors;
u32 tx_bytes;
u32 tx_64byte_frames;
u32 tx_65_to_127byte_frames;
u32 tx_128_to_255byte_frames;
u32 tx_256_to_511byte_frames;
u32 tx_512_to_1023byte_frames;
u32 tx_1024byte_frames;
u32 net_bytes;
u32 rx_sof_overruns;
u32 rx_mof_overruns;
u32 rx_dma_overruns;
};
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBE_MAX_HW_STAT_MODS 9
#define GBE_HW_STATS_REG_MAP_SZ 0x100
struct ts_ctl {
int uni;
u8 dst_port_map;
u8 maddr_map;
u8 ts_mcast_type;
};
struct gbe_slave {
void __iomem *port_regs;
void __iomem *emac_regs;
struct gbe_port_regs_ofs port_regs_ofs;
struct gbe_emac_regs_ofs emac_regs_ofs;
int slave_num; /* 0 based logical number */
int port_num; /* actual port number */
atomic_t link_state;
bool open;
struct phy_device *phy;
u32 link_interface;
u32 mac_control;
u8 phy_port_t;
struct device_node *node;
struct device_node *phy_node;
struct ts_ctl ts_ctl;
struct list_head slave_list;
};
struct gbe_priv {
struct device *dev;
struct netcp_device *netcp_device;
struct timer_list timer;
u32 num_slaves;
u32 ale_entries;
u32 ale_ports;
bool enable_ale;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
u8 max_num_slaves;
u8 max_num_ports; /* max_num_slaves + 1 */
u8 num_stats_mods;
struct netcp_tx_pipe tx_pipe;
int host_port;
u32 rx_packet_max;
u32 ss_version;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
u32 stats_en_mask;
void __iomem *ss_regs;
void __iomem *switch_regs;
void __iomem *host_port_regs;
void __iomem *ale_reg;
void __iomem *cpts_reg;
void __iomem *sgmii_port_regs;
void __iomem *sgmii_port34_regs;
void __iomem *xgbe_serdes_regs;
void __iomem *hw_stats_regs[GBE_MAX_HW_STAT_MODS];
struct gbe_ss_regs_ofs ss_regs_ofs;
struct gbe_switch_regs_ofs switch_regs_ofs;
struct gbe_host_port_regs_ofs host_port_regs_ofs;
struct cpsw_ale *ale;
unsigned int tx_queue_id;
const char *dma_chan_name;
struct list_head gbe_intf_head;
struct list_head secondary_slaves;
struct net_device *dummy_ndev;
u64 *hw_stats;
u32 *hw_stats_prev;
const struct netcp_ethtool_stat *et_stats;
int num_et_stats;
/* Lock for updating the hwstats */
spinlock_t hw_stats_lock;
int cpts_registered;
struct cpts *cpts;
int rx_ts_enabled;
int tx_ts_enabled;
};
struct gbe_intf {
struct net_device *ndev;
struct device *dev;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev;
struct netcp_tx_pipe tx_pipe;
struct gbe_slave *slave;
struct list_head gbe_intf_list;
unsigned long active_vlans[BITS_TO_LONGS(VLAN_N_VID)];
};
static struct netcp_module gbe_module;
static struct netcp_module xgbe_module;
/* Statistic management */
struct netcp_ethtool_stat {
char desc[ETH_GSTRING_LEN];
int type;
u32 size;
int offset;
};
#define GBE_STATSA_INFO(field) \
{ \
"GBE_A:"#field, GBE_STATSA_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbe_hw_stats, field), \
offsetof(struct gbe_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBE_STATSB_INFO(field) \
{ \
"GBE_B:"#field, GBE_STATSB_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbe_hw_stats, field), \
offsetof(struct gbe_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBE_STATSC_INFO(field) \
{ \
"GBE_C:"#field, GBE_STATSC_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbe_hw_stats, field), \
offsetof(struct gbe_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBE_STATSD_INFO(field) \
{ \
"GBE_D:"#field, GBE_STATSD_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbe_hw_stats, field), \
offsetof(struct gbe_hw_stats, field) \
}
static const struct netcp_ethtool_stat gbe13_et_stats[] = {
/* GBE module A */
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_crc_errors),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_align_code_errors),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_oversized_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_jabber_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_undersized_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_fragments),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_bytes),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_deferred_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_collision_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_late_collisions),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_underrun),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_bytes),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_64byte_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_65_to_127byte_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_128_to_255byte_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_256_to_511byte_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_512_to_1023byte_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(tx_1024byte_frames),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(net_bytes),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_sof_overruns),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_mof_overruns),
GBE_STATSA_INFO(rx_dma_overruns),
/* GBE module B */
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_crc_errors),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_align_code_errors),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_oversized_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_jabber_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_undersized_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_fragments),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_bytes),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_deferred_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_collision_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_late_collisions),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_underrun),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_bytes),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_64byte_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_65_to_127byte_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_128_to_255byte_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_256_to_511byte_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_512_to_1023byte_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(tx_1024byte_frames),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(net_bytes),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_sof_overruns),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_mof_overruns),
GBE_STATSB_INFO(rx_dma_overruns),
/* GBE module C */
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_crc_errors),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_align_code_errors),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_oversized_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_jabber_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_undersized_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_fragments),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_bytes),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_deferred_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_collision_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_late_collisions),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_underrun),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_bytes),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_64byte_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_65_to_127byte_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_128_to_255byte_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_256_to_511byte_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_512_to_1023byte_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(tx_1024byte_frames),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(net_bytes),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_sof_overruns),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_mof_overruns),
GBE_STATSC_INFO(rx_dma_overruns),
/* GBE module D */
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_crc_errors),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_align_code_errors),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_oversized_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_jabber_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_undersized_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_fragments),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_bytes),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_good_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_multicast_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_pause_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_deferred_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_collision_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_late_collisions),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_underrun),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_bytes),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_64byte_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_65_to_127byte_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_128_to_255byte_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_256_to_511byte_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_512_to_1023byte_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(tx_1024byte_frames),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(net_bytes),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_sof_overruns),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_mof_overruns),
GBE_STATSD_INFO(rx_dma_overruns),
};
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* This is the size of entries in GBENU_STATS_HOST */
#define GBENU_ET_STATS_HOST_SIZE 52
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBENU_STATS_HOST(field) \
{ \
"GBE_HOST:"#field, GBENU_STATS0_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
/* This is the size of entries in GBENU_STATS_PORT */
#define GBENU_ET_STATS_PORT_SIZE 65
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
#define GBENU_STATS_P1(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P1:"#field, GBENU_STATS1_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBENU_STATS_P2(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P2:"#field, GBENU_STATS2_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBENU_STATS_P3(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P3:"#field, GBENU_STATS3_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBENU_STATS_P4(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P4:"#field, GBENU_STATS4_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBENU_STATS_P5(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P5:"#field, GBENU_STATS5_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBENU_STATS_P6(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P6:"#field, GBENU_STATS6_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBENU_STATS_P7(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P7:"#field, GBENU_STATS7_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define GBENU_STATS_P8(field) \
{ \
"GBE_P8:"#field, GBENU_STATS8_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field), \
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
offsetof(struct gbenu_hw_stats, field) \
}
static const struct netcp_ethtool_stat gbenu_et_stats[] = {
/* GBENU Host Module */
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_HOST(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 1 */
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P1(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P1(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P1(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 2 */
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P2(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P2(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P2(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 3 */
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P3(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P3(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P3(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 4 */
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P4(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P4(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P4(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 5 */
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P5(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P5(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P5(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 6 */
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P6(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P6(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P6(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 7 */
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P7(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P7(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P7(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* GBENU Module 8 */
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_crc_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_align_code_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_oversized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_jabber_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_undersized_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_fragments),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_overrun_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_good_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_broadcast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_multicast_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pause_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_deferred_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_collision_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_single_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_mult_coll_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_excessive_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_late_collisions),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_ipg_error),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_64B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_65_to_127B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_128_to_255B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_256_to_511B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_512_to_1023B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_1024B_frames),
GBENU_STATS_P8(net_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_bottom_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_port_mask_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(rx_top_fifo_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_rate_limit_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_vid_ingress_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_da_eq_sa_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_unknown_ucast),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_unknown_ucast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_unknown_mcast),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_unknown_mcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_unknown_bcast),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_unknown_bcast_bytes),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_pol_match),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_pol_match_red),
GBENU_STATS_P8(ale_pol_match_yellow),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_mem_protect_err),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri0_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri1_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri2_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri3_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri4_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri5_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri6_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri7_drop),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri0_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri1_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri2_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri3_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri4_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri5_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri6_drop_bcnt),
GBENU_STATS_P8(tx_pri7_drop_bcnt),
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
};
#define XGBE_STATS0_INFO(field) \
{ \
"GBE_0:"#field, XGBE_STATS0_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct xgbe_hw_stats, field), \
offsetof(struct xgbe_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define XGBE_STATS1_INFO(field) \
{ \
"GBE_1:"#field, XGBE_STATS1_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct xgbe_hw_stats, field), \
offsetof(struct xgbe_hw_stats, field) \
}
#define XGBE_STATS2_INFO(field) \
{ \
"GBE_2:"#field, XGBE_STATS2_MODULE, \
sizeof_field(struct xgbe_hw_stats, field), \
offsetof(struct xgbe_hw_stats, field) \
}
static const struct netcp_ethtool_stat xgbe10_et_stats[] = {
/* GBE module 0 */
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_good_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_broadcast_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_multicast_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_oversized_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_undersized_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(overrun_type4),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(overrun_type5),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_bytes),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_good_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_broadcast_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_multicast_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_bytes),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_64byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_65_to_127byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_128_to_255byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_256_to_511byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_512_to_1023byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(tx_1024byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(net_bytes),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_sof_overruns),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_mof_overruns),
XGBE_STATS0_INFO(rx_dma_overruns),
/* XGBE module 1 */
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_good_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_broadcast_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_multicast_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_pause_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_crc_errors),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_align_code_errors),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_oversized_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_jabber_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_undersized_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_fragments),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(overrun_type4),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(overrun_type5),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_bytes),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_good_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_broadcast_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_multicast_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_pause_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_deferred_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_collision_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_single_coll_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_mult_coll_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_excessive_collisions),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_late_collisions),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_underrun),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_bytes),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_64byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_65_to_127byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_128_to_255byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_256_to_511byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_512_to_1023byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(tx_1024byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(net_bytes),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_sof_overruns),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_mof_overruns),
XGBE_STATS1_INFO(rx_dma_overruns),
/* XGBE module 2 */
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_good_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_broadcast_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_multicast_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_pause_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_crc_errors),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_align_code_errors),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_oversized_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_jabber_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_undersized_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_fragments),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(overrun_type4),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(overrun_type5),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_bytes),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_good_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_broadcast_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_multicast_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_pause_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_deferred_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_collision_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_single_coll_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_mult_coll_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_excessive_collisions),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_late_collisions),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_underrun),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_carrier_sense_errors),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_bytes),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_64byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_65_to_127byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_128_to_255byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_256_to_511byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_512_to_1023byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(tx_1024byte_frames),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(net_bytes),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_sof_overruns),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_mof_overruns),
XGBE_STATS2_INFO(rx_dma_overruns),
};
#define for_each_intf(i, priv) \
list_for_each_entry((i), &(priv)->gbe_intf_head, gbe_intf_list)
#define for_each_sec_slave(slave, priv) \
list_for_each_entry((slave), &(priv)->secondary_slaves, slave_list)
#define first_sec_slave(priv) \
list_first_entry(&priv->secondary_slaves, \
struct gbe_slave, slave_list)
static void keystone_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *ndev,
struct ethtool_drvinfo *info)
{
strncpy(info->driver, NETCP_DRIVER_NAME, sizeof(info->driver));
strncpy(info->version, NETCP_DRIVER_VERSION, sizeof(info->version));
}
static u32 keystone_get_msglevel(struct net_device *ndev)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
return netcp->msg_enable;
}
static void keystone_set_msglevel(struct net_device *ndev, u32 value)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
netcp->msg_enable = value;
}
static struct gbe_intf *keystone_get_intf_data(struct netcp_intf *netcp)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
gbe_intf = netcp_module_get_intf_data(&gbe_module, netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
gbe_intf = netcp_module_get_intf_data(&xgbe_module, netcp);
return gbe_intf;
}
static void keystone_get_stat_strings(struct net_device *ndev,
uint32_t stringset, uint8_t *data)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev;
int i;
gbe_intf = keystone_get_intf_data(netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
return;
gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
switch (stringset) {
case ETH_SS_STATS:
for (i = 0; i < gbe_dev->num_et_stats; i++) {
memcpy(data, gbe_dev->et_stats[i].desc,
ETH_GSTRING_LEN);
data += ETH_GSTRING_LEN;
}
break;
case ETH_SS_TEST:
break;
}
}
static int keystone_get_sset_count(struct net_device *ndev, int stringset)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev;
gbe_intf = keystone_get_intf_data(netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
return -EINVAL;
gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
switch (stringset) {
case ETH_SS_TEST:
return 0;
case ETH_SS_STATS:
return gbe_dev->num_et_stats;
default:
return -EINVAL;
}
}
static void gbe_reset_mod_stats(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev, int stats_mod)
{
void __iomem *base = gbe_dev->hw_stats_regs[stats_mod];
u32 __iomem *p_stats_entry;
int i;
for (i = 0; i < gbe_dev->num_et_stats; i++) {
if (gbe_dev->et_stats[i].type == stats_mod) {
p_stats_entry = base + gbe_dev->et_stats[i].offset;
gbe_dev->hw_stats[i] = 0;
gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev[i] = readl(p_stats_entry);
}
}
}
static inline void gbe_update_hw_stats_entry(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
int et_stats_entry)
{
void __iomem *base = NULL;
u32 __iomem *p_stats_entry;
u32 curr, delta;
/* The hw_stats_regs pointers are already
* properly set to point to the right base:
*/
base = gbe_dev->hw_stats_regs[gbe_dev->et_stats[et_stats_entry].type];
p_stats_entry = base + gbe_dev->et_stats[et_stats_entry].offset;
curr = readl(p_stats_entry);
delta = curr - gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev[et_stats_entry];
gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev[et_stats_entry] = curr;
gbe_dev->hw_stats[et_stats_entry] += delta;
}
static void gbe_update_stats(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev, uint64_t *data)
{
int i;
for (i = 0; i < gbe_dev->num_et_stats; i++) {
gbe_update_hw_stats_entry(gbe_dev, i);
if (data)
data[i] = gbe_dev->hw_stats[i];
}
}
static inline void gbe_stats_mod_visible_ver14(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
int stats_mod)
{
u32 val;
val = readl(GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, switch_regs, stat_port_en));
switch (stats_mod) {
case GBE_STATSA_MODULE:
case GBE_STATSB_MODULE:
val &= ~GBE_STATS_CD_SEL;
break;
case GBE_STATSC_MODULE:
case GBE_STATSD_MODULE:
val |= GBE_STATS_CD_SEL;
break;
default:
return;
}
/* make the stat module visible */
writel(val, GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, switch_regs, stat_port_en));
}
static void gbe_reset_mod_stats_ver14(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev, int stats_mod)
{
gbe_stats_mod_visible_ver14(gbe_dev, stats_mod);
gbe_reset_mod_stats(gbe_dev, stats_mod);
}
static void gbe_update_stats_ver14(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev, uint64_t *data)
{
u32 half_num_et_stats = (gbe_dev->num_et_stats / 2);
int et_entry, j, pair;
for (pair = 0; pair < 2; pair++) {
gbe_stats_mod_visible_ver14(gbe_dev, (pair ?
GBE_STATSC_MODULE :
GBE_STATSA_MODULE));
for (j = 0; j < half_num_et_stats; j++) {
et_entry = pair * half_num_et_stats + j;
gbe_update_hw_stats_entry(gbe_dev, et_entry);
if (data)
data[et_entry] = gbe_dev->hw_stats[et_entry];
}
}
}
static void keystone_get_ethtool_stats(struct net_device *ndev,
struct ethtool_stats *stats,
uint64_t *data)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev;
gbe_intf = keystone_get_intf_data(netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
return;
gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
spin_lock_bh(&gbe_dev->hw_stats_lock);
if (IS_SS_ID_VER_14(gbe_dev))
gbe_update_stats_ver14(gbe_dev, data);
else
gbe_update_stats(gbe_dev, data);
spin_unlock_bh(&gbe_dev->hw_stats_lock);
}
static int keystone_get_link_ksettings(struct net_device *ndev,
struct ethtool_link_ksettings *cmd)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct phy_device *phy = ndev->phydev;
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
if (!phy)
return -EINVAL;
gbe_intf = keystone_get_intf_data(netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
return -EINVAL;
if (!gbe_intf->slave)
return -EINVAL;
phy_ethtool_ksettings_get(phy, cmd);
cmd->base.port = gbe_intf->slave->phy_port_t;
return 0;
}
static int keystone_set_link_ksettings(struct net_device *ndev,
const struct ethtool_link_ksettings *cmd)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct phy_device *phy = ndev->phydev;
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
u8 port = cmd->base.port;
u32 advertising, supported;
u32 features;
ethtool_convert_link_mode_to_legacy_u32(&advertising,
cmd->link_modes.advertising);
ethtool_convert_link_mode_to_legacy_u32(&supported,
cmd->link_modes.supported);
features = advertising & supported;
if (!phy)
return -EINVAL;
gbe_intf = keystone_get_intf_data(netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
return -EINVAL;
if (!gbe_intf->slave)
return -EINVAL;
if (port != gbe_intf->slave->phy_port_t) {
if ((port == PORT_TP) && !(features & ADVERTISED_TP))
return -EINVAL;
if ((port == PORT_AUI) && !(features & ADVERTISED_AUI))
return -EINVAL;
if ((port == PORT_BNC) && !(features & ADVERTISED_BNC))
return -EINVAL;
if ((port == PORT_MII) && !(features & ADVERTISED_MII))
return -EINVAL;
if ((port == PORT_FIBRE) && !(features & ADVERTISED_FIBRE))
return -EINVAL;
}
gbe_intf->slave->phy_port_t = port;
return phy_ethtool_ksettings_set(phy, cmd);
}
#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_TI_CPTS)
static int keystone_get_ts_info(struct net_device *ndev,
struct ethtool_ts_info *info)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
gbe_intf = netcp_module_get_intf_data(&gbe_module, netcp);
if (!gbe_intf || !gbe_intf->gbe_dev->cpts)
return -EINVAL;
info->so_timestamping =
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_TX_HARDWARE |
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_TX_SOFTWARE |
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_RX_HARDWARE |
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_RX_SOFTWARE |
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_SOFTWARE |
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_RAW_HARDWARE;
info->phc_index = gbe_intf->gbe_dev->cpts->phc_index;
info->tx_types =
(1 << HWTSTAMP_TX_OFF) |
(1 << HWTSTAMP_TX_ON);
info->rx_filters =
(1 << HWTSTAMP_FILTER_NONE) |
(1 << HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V1_L4_EVENT) |
(1 << HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_EVENT);
return 0;
}
#else
static int keystone_get_ts_info(struct net_device *ndev,
struct ethtool_ts_info *info)
{
info->so_timestamping =
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_TX_SOFTWARE |
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_RX_SOFTWARE |
SOF_TIMESTAMPING_SOFTWARE;
info->phc_index = -1;
info->tx_types = 0;
info->rx_filters = 0;
return 0;
}
#endif /* CONFIG_TI_CPTS */
static const struct ethtool_ops keystone_ethtool_ops = {
.get_drvinfo = keystone_get_drvinfo,
.get_link = ethtool_op_get_link,
.get_msglevel = keystone_get_msglevel,
.set_msglevel = keystone_set_msglevel,
.get_strings = keystone_get_stat_strings,
.get_sset_count = keystone_get_sset_count,
.get_ethtool_stats = keystone_get_ethtool_stats,
.get_link_ksettings = keystone_get_link_ksettings,
.set_link_ksettings = keystone_set_link_ksettings,
.get_ts_info = keystone_get_ts_info,
};
static void gbe_set_slave_mac(struct gbe_slave *slave,
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf)
{
struct net_device *ndev = gbe_intf->ndev;
writel(mac_hi(ndev->dev_addr), GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, sa_hi));
writel(mac_lo(ndev->dev_addr), GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, sa_lo));
}
static int gbe_get_slave_port(struct gbe_priv *priv, u32 slave_num)
{
if (priv->host_port == 0)
return slave_num + 1;
return slave_num;
}
static void netcp_ethss_link_state_action(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
struct net_device *ndev,
struct gbe_slave *slave,
int up)
{
struct phy_device *phy = slave->phy;
u32 mac_control = 0;
if (up) {
mac_control = slave->mac_control;
if (phy && (phy->speed == SPEED_1000)) {
mac_control |= MACSL_GIG_MODE;
mac_control &= ~MACSL_XGIG_MODE;
} else if (phy && (phy->speed == SPEED_10000)) {
mac_control |= MACSL_XGIG_MODE;
mac_control &= ~MACSL_GIG_MODE;
}
writel(mac_control, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, emac_regs,
mac_control));
cpsw_ale_control_set(gbe_dev->ale, slave->port_num,
ALE_PORT_STATE,
ALE_PORT_STATE_FORWARD);
if (ndev && slave->open &&
((slave->link_interface != SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) &&
(slave->link_interface != RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) &&
(slave->link_interface != XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY)))
netif_carrier_on(ndev);
} else {
writel(mac_control, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, emac_regs,
mac_control));
cpsw_ale_control_set(gbe_dev->ale, slave->port_num,
ALE_PORT_STATE,
ALE_PORT_STATE_DISABLE);
if (ndev &&
((slave->link_interface != SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) &&
(slave->link_interface != RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) &&
(slave->link_interface != XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY)))
netif_carrier_off(ndev);
}
if (phy)
phy_print_status(phy);
}
static bool gbe_phy_link_status(struct gbe_slave *slave)
{
return !slave->phy || slave->phy->link;
}
#define RGMII_REG_STATUS_LINK BIT(0)
static void netcp_2u_rgmii_get_port_link(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev, bool *status)
{
u32 val = 0;
val = readl(GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, ss_regs, rgmii_status));
*status = !!(val & RGMII_REG_STATUS_LINK);
}
static void netcp_ethss_update_link_state(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
struct gbe_slave *slave,
struct net_device *ndev)
{
bool sw_link_state = true, phy_link_state;
int sp = slave->slave_num, link_state;
if (!slave->open)
return;
if (SLAVE_LINK_IS_RGMII(slave))
netcp_2u_rgmii_get_port_link(gbe_dev,
&sw_link_state);
if (SLAVE_LINK_IS_SGMII(slave))
sw_link_state =
netcp_sgmii_get_port_link(SGMII_BASE(gbe_dev, sp), sp);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
phy_link_state = gbe_phy_link_status(slave);
link_state = phy_link_state & sw_link_state;
if (atomic_xchg(&slave->link_state, link_state) != link_state)
netcp_ethss_link_state_action(gbe_dev, ndev, slave,
link_state);
}
static void xgbe_adjust_link(struct net_device *ndev)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
gbe_intf = netcp_module_get_intf_data(&xgbe_module, netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
return;
netcp_ethss_update_link_state(gbe_intf->gbe_dev, gbe_intf->slave,
ndev);
}
static void gbe_adjust_link(struct net_device *ndev)
{
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
gbe_intf = netcp_module_get_intf_data(&gbe_module, netcp);
if (!gbe_intf)
return;
netcp_ethss_update_link_state(gbe_intf->gbe_dev, gbe_intf->slave,
ndev);
}
static void gbe_adjust_link_sec_slaves(struct net_device *ndev)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_slave *slave;
for_each_sec_slave(slave, gbe_dev)
netcp_ethss_update_link_state(gbe_dev, slave, NULL);
}
/* Reset EMAC
* Soft reset is set and polled until clear, or until a timeout occurs
*/
static int gbe_port_reset(struct gbe_slave *slave)
{
u32 i, v;
/* Set the soft reset bit */
writel(SOFT_RESET, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, emac_regs, soft_reset));
/* Wait for the bit to clear */
for (i = 0; i < DEVICE_EMACSL_RESET_POLL_COUNT; i++) {
v = readl(GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, emac_regs, soft_reset));
if ((v & SOFT_RESET_MASK) != SOFT_RESET)
return 0;
}
/* Timeout on the reset */
return GMACSL_RET_WARN_RESET_INCOMPLETE;
}
/* Configure EMAC */
static void gbe_port_config(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev, struct gbe_slave *slave,
int max_rx_len)
{
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
void __iomem *rx_maxlen_reg;
u32 xgmii_mode;
if (max_rx_len > NETCP_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
max_rx_len = NETCP_MAX_FRAME_SIZE;
/* Enable correct MII mode at SS level */
if (IS_SS_ID_XGBE(gbe_dev) &&
(slave->link_interface >= XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY)) {
xgmii_mode = readl(GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, ss_regs, control));
xgmii_mode |= (1 << slave->slave_num);
writel(xgmii_mode, GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, ss_regs, control));
}
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
if (IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev))
rx_maxlen_reg = GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, rx_maxlen);
else
rx_maxlen_reg = GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, emac_regs, rx_maxlen);
writel(max_rx_len, rx_maxlen_reg);
writel(slave->mac_control, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, emac_regs, mac_control));
}
static void gbe_sgmii_rtreset(struct gbe_priv *priv,
struct gbe_slave *slave, bool set)
{
if (SLAVE_LINK_IS_XGMII(slave))
return;
netcp_sgmii_rtreset(SGMII_BASE(priv, slave->slave_num),
slave->slave_num, set);
}
static void gbe_slave_stop(struct gbe_intf *intf)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = intf->gbe_dev;
struct gbe_slave *slave = intf->slave;
if (!IS_SS_ID_2U(gbe_dev))
gbe_sgmii_rtreset(gbe_dev, slave, true);
gbe_port_reset(slave);
/* Disable forwarding */
cpsw_ale_control_set(gbe_dev->ale, slave->port_num,
ALE_PORT_STATE, ALE_PORT_STATE_DISABLE);
cpsw_ale_del_mcast(gbe_dev->ale, intf->ndev->broadcast,
1 << slave->port_num, 0, 0);
if (!slave->phy)
return;
phy_stop(slave->phy);
phy_disconnect(slave->phy);
slave->phy = NULL;
}
static void gbe_sgmii_config(struct gbe_priv *priv, struct gbe_slave *slave)
{
if (SLAVE_LINK_IS_XGMII(slave))
return;
netcp_sgmii_reset(SGMII_BASE(priv, slave->slave_num), slave->slave_num);
netcp_sgmii_config(SGMII_BASE(priv, slave->slave_num), slave->slave_num,
slave->link_interface);
}
static int gbe_slave_open(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf)
{
struct gbe_priv *priv = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
struct gbe_slave *slave = gbe_intf->slave;
phy_interface_t phy_mode;
bool has_phy = false;
int err;
void (*hndlr)(struct net_device *) = gbe_adjust_link;
if (!IS_SS_ID_2U(priv))
gbe_sgmii_config(priv, slave);
gbe_port_reset(slave);
if (!IS_SS_ID_2U(priv))
gbe_sgmii_rtreset(priv, slave, false);
gbe_port_config(priv, slave, priv->rx_packet_max);
gbe_set_slave_mac(slave, gbe_intf);
/* For NU & 2U switch, map the vlan priorities to zero
* as we only configure to use priority 0
*/
if (IS_SS_ID_MU(priv))
writel(HOST_TX_PRI_MAP_DEFAULT,
GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, rx_pri_map));
/* enable forwarding */
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, slave->port_num,
ALE_PORT_STATE, ALE_PORT_STATE_FORWARD);
cpsw_ale_add_mcast(priv->ale, gbe_intf->ndev->broadcast,
1 << slave->port_num, 0, 0, ALE_MCAST_FWD_2);
if (slave->link_interface == SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) {
has_phy = true;
phy_mode = PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_SGMII;
slave->phy_port_t = PORT_MII;
} else if (slave->link_interface == RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) {
has_phy = true;
err = of_get_phy_mode(slave->node, &phy_mode);
/* if phy-mode is not present, default to
* PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_RGMII
*/
if (err)
phy_mode = PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_RGMII;
if (!phy_interface_mode_is_rgmii(phy_mode)) {
dev_err(priv->dev,
"Unsupported phy mode %d\n", phy_mode);
return -EINVAL;
}
slave->phy_port_t = PORT_MII;
} else if (slave->link_interface == XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) {
has_phy = true;
phy_mode = PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_NA;
slave->phy_port_t = PORT_FIBRE;
}
if (has_phy) {
if (IS_SS_ID_XGBE(priv))
hndlr = xgbe_adjust_link;
slave->phy = of_phy_connect(gbe_intf->ndev,
slave->phy_node,
hndlr, 0,
phy_mode);
if (!slave->phy) {
dev_err(priv->dev, "phy not found on slave %d\n",
slave->slave_num);
return -ENODEV;
}
dev_dbg(priv->dev, "phy found: id is: 0x%s\n",
phydev_name(slave->phy));
phy_start(slave->phy);
}
return 0;
}
static void gbe_init_host_port(struct gbe_priv *priv)
{
int bypass_en = 1;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* Host Tx Pri */
if (IS_SS_ID_NU(priv) || IS_SS_ID_XGBE(priv))
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
writel(HOST_TX_PRI_MAP_DEFAULT,
GBE_REG_ADDR(priv, host_port_regs, tx_pri_map));
/* Max length register */
writel(NETCP_MAX_FRAME_SIZE, GBE_REG_ADDR(priv, host_port_regs,
rx_maxlen));
cpsw_ale_start(priv->ale);
if (priv->enable_ale)
bypass_en = 0;
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, 0, ALE_BYPASS, bypass_en);
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, 0, ALE_NO_PORT_VLAN, 1);
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, priv->host_port,
ALE_PORT_STATE, ALE_PORT_STATE_FORWARD);
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, 0,
ALE_PORT_UNKNOWN_VLAN_MEMBER,
GBE_PORT_MASK(priv->ale_ports));
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, 0,
ALE_PORT_UNKNOWN_MCAST_FLOOD,
GBE_PORT_MASK(priv->ale_ports - 1));
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, 0,
ALE_PORT_UNKNOWN_REG_MCAST_FLOOD,
GBE_PORT_MASK(priv->ale_ports));
cpsw_ale_control_set(priv->ale, 0,
ALE_PORT_UNTAGGED_EGRESS,
GBE_PORT_MASK(priv->ale_ports));
}
static void gbe_add_mcast_addr(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, u8 *addr)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
u16 vlan_id;
cpsw_ale_add_mcast(gbe_dev->ale, addr,
GBE_PORT_MASK(gbe_dev->ale_ports), 0, 0,
ALE_MCAST_FWD_2);
for_each_set_bit(vlan_id, gbe_intf->active_vlans, VLAN_N_VID) {
cpsw_ale_add_mcast(gbe_dev->ale, addr,
GBE_PORT_MASK(gbe_dev->ale_ports),
ALE_VLAN, vlan_id, ALE_MCAST_FWD_2);
}
}
static void gbe_add_ucast_addr(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, u8 *addr)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
u16 vlan_id;
cpsw_ale_add_ucast(gbe_dev->ale, addr, gbe_dev->host_port, 0, 0);
for_each_set_bit(vlan_id, gbe_intf->active_vlans, VLAN_N_VID)
cpsw_ale_add_ucast(gbe_dev->ale, addr, gbe_dev->host_port,
ALE_VLAN, vlan_id);
}
static void gbe_del_mcast_addr(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, u8 *addr)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
u16 vlan_id;
cpsw_ale_del_mcast(gbe_dev->ale, addr, 0, 0, 0);
for_each_set_bit(vlan_id, gbe_intf->active_vlans, VLAN_N_VID) {
cpsw_ale_del_mcast(gbe_dev->ale, addr, 0, ALE_VLAN, vlan_id);
}
}
static void gbe_del_ucast_addr(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, u8 *addr)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
u16 vlan_id;
cpsw_ale_del_ucast(gbe_dev->ale, addr, gbe_dev->host_port, 0, 0);
for_each_set_bit(vlan_id, gbe_intf->active_vlans, VLAN_N_VID) {
cpsw_ale_del_ucast(gbe_dev->ale, addr, gbe_dev->host_port,
ALE_VLAN, vlan_id);
}
}
static int gbe_add_addr(void *intf_priv, struct netcp_addr *naddr)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
dev_dbg(gbe_dev->dev, "ethss adding address %pM, type %d\n",
naddr->addr, naddr->type);
switch (naddr->type) {
case ADDR_MCAST:
case ADDR_BCAST:
gbe_add_mcast_addr(gbe_intf, naddr->addr);
break;
case ADDR_UCAST:
case ADDR_DEV:
gbe_add_ucast_addr(gbe_intf, naddr->addr);
break;
case ADDR_ANY:
/* nothing to do for promiscuous */
default:
break;
}
return 0;
}
static int gbe_del_addr(void *intf_priv, struct netcp_addr *naddr)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
dev_dbg(gbe_dev->dev, "ethss deleting address %pM, type %d\n",
naddr->addr, naddr->type);
switch (naddr->type) {
case ADDR_MCAST:
case ADDR_BCAST:
gbe_del_mcast_addr(gbe_intf, naddr->addr);
break;
case ADDR_UCAST:
case ADDR_DEV:
gbe_del_ucast_addr(gbe_intf, naddr->addr);
break;
case ADDR_ANY:
/* nothing to do for promiscuous */
default:
break;
}
return 0;
}
static int gbe_add_vid(void *intf_priv, int vid)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
set_bit(vid, gbe_intf->active_vlans);
cpsw_ale_add_vlan(gbe_dev->ale, vid,
GBE_PORT_MASK(gbe_dev->ale_ports),
GBE_MASK_NO_PORTS,
GBE_PORT_MASK(gbe_dev->ale_ports),
GBE_PORT_MASK(gbe_dev->ale_ports - 1));
return 0;
}
static int gbe_del_vid(void *intf_priv, int vid)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
cpsw_ale_del_vlan(gbe_dev->ale, vid, 0);
clear_bit(vid, gbe_intf->active_vlans);
return 0;
}
#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_TI_CPTS)
#define HAS_PHY_TXTSTAMP(p) ((p)->drv && (p)->drv->txtstamp)
#define HAS_PHY_RXTSTAMP(p) ((p)->drv && (p)->drv->rxtstamp)
static void gbe_txtstamp(void *context, struct sk_buff *skb)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = context;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
cpts_tx_timestamp(gbe_dev->cpts, skb);
}
static bool gbe_need_txtstamp(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf,
const struct netcp_packet *p_info)
{
struct sk_buff *skb = p_info->skb;
return cpts_can_timestamp(gbe_intf->gbe_dev->cpts, skb);
}
static int gbe_txtstamp_mark_pkt(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf,
struct netcp_packet *p_info)
{
struct phy_device *phydev = p_info->skb->dev->phydev;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
if (!(skb_shinfo(p_info->skb)->tx_flags & SKBTX_HW_TSTAMP) ||
!gbe_dev->tx_ts_enabled)
return 0;
/* If phy has the txtstamp api, assume it will do it.
* We mark it here because skb_tx_timestamp() is called
* after all the txhooks are called.
*/
if (phydev && HAS_PHY_TXTSTAMP(phydev)) {
skb_shinfo(p_info->skb)->tx_flags |= SKBTX_IN_PROGRESS;
return 0;
}
if (gbe_need_txtstamp(gbe_intf, p_info)) {
p_info->txtstamp = gbe_txtstamp;
p_info->ts_context = (void *)gbe_intf;
skb_shinfo(p_info->skb)->tx_flags |= SKBTX_IN_PROGRESS;
}
return 0;
}
static int gbe_rxtstamp(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, struct netcp_packet *p_info)
{
struct phy_device *phydev = p_info->skb->dev->phydev;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
if (p_info->rxtstamp_complete)
return 0;
if (phydev && HAS_PHY_RXTSTAMP(phydev)) {
p_info->rxtstamp_complete = true;
return 0;
}
if (gbe_dev->rx_ts_enabled)
cpts_rx_timestamp(gbe_dev->cpts, p_info->skb);
p_info->rxtstamp_complete = true;
return 0;
}
static int gbe_hwtstamp_get(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, struct ifreq *ifr)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
struct cpts *cpts = gbe_dev->cpts;
struct hwtstamp_config cfg;
if (!cpts)
return -EOPNOTSUPP;
cfg.flags = 0;
cfg.tx_type = gbe_dev->tx_ts_enabled ? HWTSTAMP_TX_ON : HWTSTAMP_TX_OFF;
cfg.rx_filter = gbe_dev->rx_ts_enabled;
return copy_to_user(ifr->ifr_data, &cfg, sizeof(cfg)) ? -EFAULT : 0;
}
static void gbe_hwtstamp(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
struct gbe_slave *slave = gbe_intf->slave;
u32 ts_en, seq_id, ctl;
if (!gbe_dev->rx_ts_enabled &&
!gbe_dev->tx_ts_enabled) {
writel(0, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl));
return;
}
seq_id = (30 << TS_SEQ_ID_OFS_SHIFT) | ETH_P_1588;
ts_en = EVENT_MSG_BITS << TS_MSG_TYPE_EN_SHIFT;
ctl = ETH_P_1588 | TS_TTL_NONZERO |
(slave->ts_ctl.dst_port_map << TS_CTL_DST_PORT_SHIFT) |
(slave->ts_ctl.uni ? TS_UNI_EN :
slave->ts_ctl.maddr_map << TS_CTL_MADDR_SHIFT);
if (gbe_dev->tx_ts_enabled)
ts_en |= (TS_TX_ANX_ALL_EN | TS_TX_VLAN_LT1_EN);
if (gbe_dev->rx_ts_enabled)
ts_en |= (TS_RX_ANX_ALL_EN | TS_RX_VLAN_LT1_EN);
writel(ts_en, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl));
writel(seq_id, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, ts_seq_ltype));
writel(ctl, GBE_REG_ADDR(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl_ltype2));
}
static int gbe_hwtstamp_set(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, struct ifreq *ifr)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
struct cpts *cpts = gbe_dev->cpts;
struct hwtstamp_config cfg;
if (!cpts)
return -EOPNOTSUPP;
if (copy_from_user(&cfg, ifr->ifr_data, sizeof(cfg)))
return -EFAULT;
/* reserved for future extensions */
if (cfg.flags)
return -EINVAL;
switch (cfg.tx_type) {
case HWTSTAMP_TX_OFF:
gbe_dev->tx_ts_enabled = 0;
break;
case HWTSTAMP_TX_ON:
gbe_dev->tx_ts_enabled = 1;
break;
default:
return -ERANGE;
}
switch (cfg.rx_filter) {
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_NONE:
gbe_dev->rx_ts_enabled = HWTSTAMP_FILTER_NONE;
break;
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V1_L4_EVENT:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V1_L4_SYNC:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V1_L4_DELAY_REQ:
gbe_dev->rx_ts_enabled = HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V1_L4_EVENT;
cfg.rx_filter = HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V1_L4_EVENT;
break;
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_L4_EVENT:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_L4_SYNC:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_L4_DELAY_REQ:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_L2_EVENT:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_L2_SYNC:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_L2_DELAY_REQ:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_EVENT:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_SYNC:
case HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_DELAY_REQ:
gbe_dev->rx_ts_enabled = HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_EVENT;
cfg.rx_filter = HWTSTAMP_FILTER_PTP_V2_EVENT;
break;
default:
return -ERANGE;
}
gbe_hwtstamp(gbe_intf);
return copy_to_user(ifr->ifr_data, &cfg, sizeof(cfg)) ? -EFAULT : 0;
}
static void gbe_register_cpts(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev)
{
if (!gbe_dev->cpts)
return;
if (gbe_dev->cpts_registered > 0)
goto done;
if (cpts_register(gbe_dev->cpts)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "error registering cpts device\n");
return;
}
done:
++gbe_dev->cpts_registered;
}
static void gbe_unregister_cpts(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev)
{
if (!gbe_dev->cpts || (gbe_dev->cpts_registered <= 0))
return;
if (--gbe_dev->cpts_registered)
return;
cpts_unregister(gbe_dev->cpts);
}
#else
static inline int gbe_txtstamp_mark_pkt(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf,
struct netcp_packet *p_info)
{
return 0;
}
static inline int gbe_rxtstamp(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf,
struct netcp_packet *p_info)
{
return 0;
}
static inline int gbe_hwtstamp(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf,
struct ifreq *ifr, int cmd)
{
return -EOPNOTSUPP;
}
static inline void gbe_register_cpts(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev)
{
}
static inline void gbe_unregister_cpts(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev)
{
}
static inline int gbe_hwtstamp_get(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, struct ifreq *req)
{
return -EOPNOTSUPP;
}
static inline int gbe_hwtstamp_set(struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf, struct ifreq *req)
{
return -EOPNOTSUPP;
}
#endif /* CONFIG_TI_CPTS */
static int gbe_set_rx_mode(void *intf_priv, bool promisc)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
struct cpsw_ale *ale = gbe_dev->ale;
unsigned long timeout;
int i, ret = -ETIMEDOUT;
/* Disable(1)/Enable(0) Learn for all ports (host is port 0 and
* slaves are port 1 and up
*/
for (i = 0; i <= gbe_dev->num_slaves; i++) {
cpsw_ale_control_set(ale, i,
ALE_PORT_NOLEARN, !!promisc);
cpsw_ale_control_set(ale, i,
ALE_PORT_NO_SA_UPDATE, !!promisc);
}
if (!promisc) {
/* Don't Flood All Unicast Packets to Host port */
cpsw_ale_control_set(ale, 0, ALE_P0_UNI_FLOOD, 0);
dev_vdbg(gbe_dev->dev, "promiscuous mode disabled\n");
return 0;
}
timeout = jiffies + HZ;
/* Clear All Untouched entries */
cpsw_ale_control_set(ale, 0, ALE_AGEOUT, 1);
do {
cpu_relax();
if (cpsw_ale_control_get(ale, 0, ALE_AGEOUT)) {
ret = 0;
break;
}
} while (time_after(timeout, jiffies));
/* Make sure it is not a false timeout */
if (ret && !cpsw_ale_control_get(ale, 0, ALE_AGEOUT))
return ret;
cpsw_ale_control_set(ale, 0, ALE_AGEOUT, 1);
/* Clear all mcast from ALE */
cpsw_ale_flush_multicast(ale,
GBE_PORT_MASK(gbe_dev->ale_ports),
-1);
/* Flood All Unicast Packets to Host port */
cpsw_ale_control_set(ale, 0, ALE_P0_UNI_FLOOD, 1);
dev_vdbg(gbe_dev->dev, "promiscuous mode enabled\n");
return ret;
}
static int gbe_ioctl(void *intf_priv, struct ifreq *req, int cmd)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct phy_device *phy = gbe_intf->slave->phy;
if (!phy || !phy->drv->hwtstamp) {
switch (cmd) {
case SIOCGHWTSTAMP:
return gbe_hwtstamp_get(gbe_intf, req);
case SIOCSHWTSTAMP:
return gbe_hwtstamp_set(gbe_intf, req);
}
}
if (phy)
return phy_mii_ioctl(phy, req, cmd);
return -EOPNOTSUPP;
}
treewide: setup_timer() -> timer_setup() This converts all remaining cases of the old setup_timer() API into using timer_setup(), where the callback argument is the structure already holding the struct timer_list. These should have no behavioral changes, since they just change which pointer is passed into the callback with the same available pointers after conversion. It handles the following examples, in addition to some other variations. Casting from unsigned long: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { struct something *ptr = (struct something *)data; ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, ptr); and forced object casts: void my_callback(struct something *ptr) { ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, (unsigned long)ptr); become: void my_callback(struct timer_list *t) { struct something *ptr = from_timer(ptr, t, my_timer); ... } ... timer_setup(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); Direct function assignments: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { struct something *ptr = (struct something *)data; ... } ... ptr->my_timer.function = my_callback; have a temporary cast added, along with converting the args: void my_callback(struct timer_list *t) { struct something *ptr = from_timer(ptr, t, my_timer); ... } ... ptr->my_timer.function = (TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)my_callback; And finally, callbacks without a data assignment: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); have their argument renamed to verify they're unused during conversion: void my_callback(struct timer_list *unused) { ... } ... timer_setup(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); The conversion is done with the following Coccinelle script: spatch --very-quiet --all-includes --include-headers \ -I ./arch/x86/include -I ./arch/x86/include/generated \ -I ./include -I ./arch/x86/include/uapi \ -I ./arch/x86/include/generated/uapi -I ./include/uapi \ -I ./include/generated/uapi --include ./include/linux/kconfig.h \ --dir . \ --cocci-file ~/src/data/timer_setup.cocci @fix_address_of@ expression e; @@ setup_timer( -&(e) +&e , ...) // Update any raw setup_timer() usages that have a NULL callback, but // would otherwise match change_timer_function_usage, since the latter // will update all function assignments done in the face of a NULL // function initialization in setup_timer(). @change_timer_function_usage_NULL@ expression _E; identifier _timer; type _cast_data; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, NULL, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, NULL, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, NULL, &_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, NULL, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, NULL, 0); ) @change_timer_function_usage@ expression _E; identifier _timer; struct timer_list _stl; identifier _callback; type _cast_func, _cast_data; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, &_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | _E->_timer@_stl.function = _callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = &_callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)_callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)&_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = _callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = &_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)&_callback; ) // callback(unsigned long arg) @change_callback_handle_cast depends on change_timer_function_usage@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; type _handletype; identifier _handle; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *t ) { ( ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle = -(_handletype *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle = -(void *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle; ... when != _handle _handle = -(_handletype *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle; ... when != _handle _handle = -(void *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg ) } // callback(unsigned long arg) without existing variable @change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; type _handletype; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *t ) { + _handletype *_origarg = from_timer(_origarg, t, _timer); + ... when != _origarg - (_handletype *)_origarg + _origarg ... when != _origarg } // Avoid already converted callbacks. @match_callback_converted depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier t; @@ void _callback(struct timer_list *t) { ... } // callback(struct something *handle) @change_callback_handle_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && !match_callback_converted && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _handletype; identifier _handle; @@ void _callback( -_handletype *_handle +struct timer_list *t ) { + _handletype *_handle = from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... } // If change_callback_handle_arg ran on an empty function, remove // the added handler. @unchange_callback_handle_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && change_callback_handle_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _handletype; identifier _handle; identifier t; @@ void _callback(struct timer_list *t) { - _handletype *_handle = from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); } // We only want to refactor the setup_timer() data argument if we've found // the matching callback. This undoes changes in change_timer_function_usage. @unchange_timer_function_usage depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg && !change_callback_handle_arg@ expression change_timer_function_usage._E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type change_timer_function_usage._cast_data; @@ ( -timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); +setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); | -timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); +setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)&_E); ) // If we fixed a callback from a .function assignment, fix the // assignment cast now. @change_timer_function_assignment depends on change_timer_function_usage && (change_callback_handle_cast || change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg || change_callback_handle_arg)@ expression change_timer_function_usage._E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type _cast_func; typedef TIMER_FUNC_TYPE; @@ ( _E->_timer.function = -_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -(_cast_func)_callback; +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -(_cast_func)&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -&_callback; +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -(_cast_func)_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -(_cast_func)&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; ) // Sometimes timer functions are called directly. Replace matched args. @change_timer_function_calls depends on change_timer_function_usage && (change_callback_handle_cast || change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg || change_callback_handle_arg)@ expression _E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type _cast_data; @@ _callback( ( -(_cast_data)_E +&_E->_timer | -(_cast_data)&_E +&_E._timer | -_E +&_E->_timer ) ) // If a timer has been configured without a data argument, it can be // converted without regard to the callback argument, since it is unused. @match_timer_function_unused_data@ expression _E; identifier _timer; identifier _callback; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); ) @change_callback_unused_data depends on match_timer_function_unused_data@ identifier match_timer_function_unused_data._callback; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *unused ) { ... when != _origarg } Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2017-10-16 15:43:17 -06:00
static void netcp_ethss_timer(struct timer_list *t)
{
treewide: setup_timer() -> timer_setup() This converts all remaining cases of the old setup_timer() API into using timer_setup(), where the callback argument is the structure already holding the struct timer_list. These should have no behavioral changes, since they just change which pointer is passed into the callback with the same available pointers after conversion. It handles the following examples, in addition to some other variations. Casting from unsigned long: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { struct something *ptr = (struct something *)data; ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, ptr); and forced object casts: void my_callback(struct something *ptr) { ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, (unsigned long)ptr); become: void my_callback(struct timer_list *t) { struct something *ptr = from_timer(ptr, t, my_timer); ... } ... timer_setup(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); Direct function assignments: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { struct something *ptr = (struct something *)data; ... } ... ptr->my_timer.function = my_callback; have a temporary cast added, along with converting the args: void my_callback(struct timer_list *t) { struct something *ptr = from_timer(ptr, t, my_timer); ... } ... ptr->my_timer.function = (TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)my_callback; And finally, callbacks without a data assignment: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); have their argument renamed to verify they're unused during conversion: void my_callback(struct timer_list *unused) { ... } ... timer_setup(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); The conversion is done with the following Coccinelle script: spatch --very-quiet --all-includes --include-headers \ -I ./arch/x86/include -I ./arch/x86/include/generated \ -I ./include -I ./arch/x86/include/uapi \ -I ./arch/x86/include/generated/uapi -I ./include/uapi \ -I ./include/generated/uapi --include ./include/linux/kconfig.h \ --dir . \ --cocci-file ~/src/data/timer_setup.cocci @fix_address_of@ expression e; @@ setup_timer( -&(e) +&e , ...) // Update any raw setup_timer() usages that have a NULL callback, but // would otherwise match change_timer_function_usage, since the latter // will update all function assignments done in the face of a NULL // function initialization in setup_timer(). @change_timer_function_usage_NULL@ expression _E; identifier _timer; type _cast_data; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, NULL, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, NULL, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, NULL, &_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, NULL, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, NULL, 0); ) @change_timer_function_usage@ expression _E; identifier _timer; struct timer_list _stl; identifier _callback; type _cast_func, _cast_data; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, &_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | _E->_timer@_stl.function = _callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = &_callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)_callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)&_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = _callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = &_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)&_callback; ) // callback(unsigned long arg) @change_callback_handle_cast depends on change_timer_function_usage@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; type _handletype; identifier _handle; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *t ) { ( ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle = -(_handletype *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle = -(void *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle; ... when != _handle _handle = -(_handletype *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle; ... when != _handle _handle = -(void *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg ) } // callback(unsigned long arg) without existing variable @change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; type _handletype; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *t ) { + _handletype *_origarg = from_timer(_origarg, t, _timer); + ... when != _origarg - (_handletype *)_origarg + _origarg ... when != _origarg } // Avoid already converted callbacks. @match_callback_converted depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier t; @@ void _callback(struct timer_list *t) { ... } // callback(struct something *handle) @change_callback_handle_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && !match_callback_converted && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _handletype; identifier _handle; @@ void _callback( -_handletype *_handle +struct timer_list *t ) { + _handletype *_handle = from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... } // If change_callback_handle_arg ran on an empty function, remove // the added handler. @unchange_callback_handle_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && change_callback_handle_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _handletype; identifier _handle; identifier t; @@ void _callback(struct timer_list *t) { - _handletype *_handle = from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); } // We only want to refactor the setup_timer() data argument if we've found // the matching callback. This undoes changes in change_timer_function_usage. @unchange_timer_function_usage depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg && !change_callback_handle_arg@ expression change_timer_function_usage._E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type change_timer_function_usage._cast_data; @@ ( -timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); +setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); | -timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); +setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)&_E); ) // If we fixed a callback from a .function assignment, fix the // assignment cast now. @change_timer_function_assignment depends on change_timer_function_usage && (change_callback_handle_cast || change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg || change_callback_handle_arg)@ expression change_timer_function_usage._E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type _cast_func; typedef TIMER_FUNC_TYPE; @@ ( _E->_timer.function = -_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -(_cast_func)_callback; +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -(_cast_func)&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -&_callback; +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -(_cast_func)_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -(_cast_func)&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; ) // Sometimes timer functions are called directly. Replace matched args. @change_timer_function_calls depends on change_timer_function_usage && (change_callback_handle_cast || change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg || change_callback_handle_arg)@ expression _E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type _cast_data; @@ _callback( ( -(_cast_data)_E +&_E->_timer | -(_cast_data)&_E +&_E._timer | -_E +&_E->_timer ) ) // If a timer has been configured without a data argument, it can be // converted without regard to the callback argument, since it is unused. @match_timer_function_unused_data@ expression _E; identifier _timer; identifier _callback; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); ) @change_callback_unused_data depends on match_timer_function_unused_data@ identifier match_timer_function_unused_data._callback; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *unused ) { ... when != _origarg } Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2017-10-16 15:43:17 -06:00
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = from_timer(gbe_dev, t, timer);
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
struct gbe_slave *slave;
/* Check & update SGMII link state of interfaces */
for_each_intf(gbe_intf, gbe_dev) {
if (!gbe_intf->slave->open)
continue;
netcp_ethss_update_link_state(gbe_dev, gbe_intf->slave,
gbe_intf->ndev);
}
/* Check & update SGMII link state of secondary ports */
for_each_sec_slave(slave, gbe_dev) {
netcp_ethss_update_link_state(gbe_dev, slave, NULL);
}
/* A timer runs as a BH, no need to block them */
spin_lock(&gbe_dev->hw_stats_lock);
if (IS_SS_ID_VER_14(gbe_dev))
gbe_update_stats_ver14(gbe_dev, NULL);
else
gbe_update_stats(gbe_dev, NULL);
spin_unlock(&gbe_dev->hw_stats_lock);
gbe_dev->timer.expires = jiffies + GBE_TIMER_INTERVAL;
add_timer(&gbe_dev->timer);
}
static int gbe_txhook(int order, void *data, struct netcp_packet *p_info)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = data;
p_info->tx_pipe = &gbe_intf->tx_pipe;
return gbe_txtstamp_mark_pkt(gbe_intf, p_info);
}
static int gbe_rxhook(int order, void *data, struct netcp_packet *p_info)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = data;
return gbe_rxtstamp(gbe_intf, p_info);
}
static int gbe_open(void *intf_priv, struct net_device *ndev)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_slave *slave = gbe_intf->slave;
int port_num = slave->port_num;
u32 reg, val;
int ret;
reg = readl(GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, switch_regs, id_ver));
dev_dbg(gbe_dev->dev, "initializing gbe version %d.%d (%d) GBE identification value 0x%x\n",
GBE_MAJOR_VERSION(reg), GBE_MINOR_VERSION(reg),
GBE_RTL_VERSION(reg), GBE_IDENT(reg));
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* For 10G and on NetCP 1.5, use directed to port */
if (IS_SS_ID_XGBE(gbe_dev) || IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev))
gbe_intf->tx_pipe.flags = SWITCH_TO_PORT_IN_TAGINFO;
if (gbe_dev->enable_ale)
gbe_intf->tx_pipe.switch_to_port = 0;
else
gbe_intf->tx_pipe.switch_to_port = port_num;
dev_dbg(gbe_dev->dev,
"opened TX channel %s: %p with to port %d, flags %d\n",
gbe_intf->tx_pipe.dma_chan_name,
gbe_intf->tx_pipe.dma_channel,
gbe_intf->tx_pipe.switch_to_port,
gbe_intf->tx_pipe.flags);
gbe_slave_stop(gbe_intf);
/* disable priority elevation and enable statistics on all ports */
writel(0, GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, switch_regs, ptype));
/* Control register */
val = GBE_CTL_P0_ENABLE;
if (IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev)) {
val |= ETH_SW_CTL_P0_TX_CRC_REMOVE;
netcp->hw_cap = ETH_SW_CAN_REMOVE_ETH_FCS;
}
writel(val, GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, switch_regs, control));
/* All statistics enabled and STAT AB visible by default */
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
writel(gbe_dev->stats_en_mask, GBE_REG_ADDR(gbe_dev, switch_regs,
stat_port_en));
ret = gbe_slave_open(gbe_intf);
if (ret)
goto fail;
netcp_register_txhook(netcp, GBE_TXHOOK_ORDER, gbe_txhook, gbe_intf);
netcp_register_rxhook(netcp, GBE_RXHOOK_ORDER, gbe_rxhook, gbe_intf);
slave->open = true;
netcp_ethss_update_link_state(gbe_dev, slave, ndev);
gbe_register_cpts(gbe_dev);
return 0;
fail:
gbe_slave_stop(gbe_intf);
return ret;
}
static int gbe_close(void *intf_priv, struct net_device *ndev)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
struct netcp_intf *netcp = netdev_priv(ndev);
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = gbe_intf->gbe_dev;
gbe_unregister_cpts(gbe_dev);
gbe_slave_stop(gbe_intf);
netcp_unregister_rxhook(netcp, GBE_RXHOOK_ORDER, gbe_rxhook, gbe_intf);
netcp_unregister_txhook(netcp, GBE_TXHOOK_ORDER, gbe_txhook, gbe_intf);
gbe_intf->slave->open = false;
atomic_set(&gbe_intf->slave->link_state, NETCP_LINK_STATE_INVALID);
return 0;
}
#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_TI_CPTS)
static void init_slave_ts_ctl(struct gbe_slave *slave)
{
slave->ts_ctl.uni = 1;
slave->ts_ctl.dst_port_map =
(TS_CTL_DST_PORT >> TS_CTL_DST_PORT_SHIFT) & 0x3;
slave->ts_ctl.maddr_map =
(TS_CTL_MADDR_ALL >> TS_CTL_MADDR_SHIFT) & 0x1f;
}
#else
static void init_slave_ts_ctl(struct gbe_slave *slave)
{
}
#endif /* CONFIG_TI_CPTS */
static int init_slave(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev, struct gbe_slave *slave,
struct device_node *node)
{
int port_reg_num;
u32 port_reg_ofs, emac_reg_ofs;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
u32 port_reg_blk_sz, emac_reg_blk_sz;
if (of_property_read_u32(node, "slave-port", &slave->slave_num)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "missing slave-port parameter\n");
return -EINVAL;
}
if (of_property_read_u32(node, "link-interface",
&slave->link_interface)) {
dev_warn(gbe_dev->dev,
"missing link-interface value defaulting to 1G mac-phy link\n");
slave->link_interface = SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY;
}
slave->node = node;
slave->open = false;
if ((slave->link_interface == SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) ||
(slave->link_interface == RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) ||
(slave->link_interface == XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY))
slave->phy_node = of_parse_phandle(node, "phy-handle", 0);
slave->port_num = gbe_get_slave_port(gbe_dev, slave->slave_num);
if (slave->link_interface >= XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY)
slave->mac_control = GBE_DEF_10G_MAC_CONTROL;
else
slave->mac_control = GBE_DEF_1G_MAC_CONTROL;
/* Emac regs memmap are contiguous but port regs are not */
port_reg_num = slave->slave_num;
if (IS_SS_ID_VER_14(gbe_dev)) {
if (slave->slave_num > 1) {
port_reg_ofs = GBE13_SLAVE_PORT2_OFFSET;
port_reg_num -= 2;
} else {
port_reg_ofs = GBE13_SLAVE_PORT_OFFSET;
}
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
emac_reg_ofs = GBE13_EMAC_OFFSET;
port_reg_blk_sz = 0x30;
emac_reg_blk_sz = 0x40;
} else if (IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev)) {
port_reg_ofs = GBENU_SLAVE_PORT_OFFSET;
emac_reg_ofs = GBENU_EMAC_OFFSET;
port_reg_blk_sz = 0x1000;
emac_reg_blk_sz = 0x1000;
} else if (IS_SS_ID_XGBE(gbe_dev)) {
port_reg_ofs = XGBE10_SLAVE_PORT_OFFSET;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
emac_reg_ofs = XGBE10_EMAC_OFFSET;
port_reg_blk_sz = 0x30;
emac_reg_blk_sz = 0x40;
} else {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "unknown ethss(0x%x)\n",
gbe_dev->ss_version);
return -EINVAL;
}
slave->port_regs = gbe_dev->switch_regs + port_reg_ofs +
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
(port_reg_blk_sz * port_reg_num);
slave->emac_regs = gbe_dev->switch_regs + emac_reg_ofs +
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
(emac_reg_blk_sz * slave->slave_num);
if (IS_SS_ID_VER_14(gbe_dev)) {
/* Initialize slave port register offsets */
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, port_vlan);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, tx_pri_map);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, sa_lo);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, sa_hi);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_seq_ltype);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_vlan);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl_ltype2);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl2);
/* Initialize EMAC register offsets */
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, mac_control);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, soft_reset);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, rx_maxlen);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
} else if (IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev)) {
/* Initialize slave port register offsets */
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, port_vlan);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, tx_pri_map);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, rx_pri_map);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, sa_lo);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, sa_hi);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_seq_ltype);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_vlan);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl_ltype2);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl2);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, rx_maxlen);
/* Initialize EMAC register offsets */
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, mac_control);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, soft_reset);
} else if (IS_SS_ID_XGBE(gbe_dev)) {
/* Initialize slave port register offsets */
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, port_vlan);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, tx_pri_map);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, sa_lo);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, sa_hi);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_seq_ltype);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_vlan);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl_ltype2);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, port_regs, ts_ctl2);
/* Initialize EMAC register offsets */
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, mac_control);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, soft_reset);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(slave, emac_regs, rx_maxlen);
}
atomic_set(&slave->link_state, NETCP_LINK_STATE_INVALID);
init_slave_ts_ctl(slave);
return 0;
}
static void init_secondary_ports(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
struct device_node *node)
{
struct device *dev = gbe_dev->dev;
phy_interface_t phy_mode;
struct gbe_priv **priv;
struct device_node *port;
struct gbe_slave *slave;
bool mac_phy_link = false;
for_each_child_of_node(node, port) {
slave = devm_kzalloc(dev, sizeof(*slave), GFP_KERNEL);
if (!slave) {
dev_err(dev, "memory alloc failed for secondary port(%pOFn), skipping...\n",
port);
continue;
}
if (init_slave(gbe_dev, slave, port)) {
dev_err(dev,
"Failed to initialize secondary port(%pOFn), skipping...\n",
port);
devm_kfree(dev, slave);
continue;
}
if (!IS_SS_ID_2U(gbe_dev))
gbe_sgmii_config(gbe_dev, slave);
gbe_port_reset(slave);
gbe_port_config(gbe_dev, slave, gbe_dev->rx_packet_max);
list_add_tail(&slave->slave_list, &gbe_dev->secondary_slaves);
gbe_dev->num_slaves++;
if ((slave->link_interface == SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) ||
(slave->link_interface == XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY))
mac_phy_link = true;
slave->open = true;
if (gbe_dev->num_slaves >= gbe_dev->max_num_slaves) {
of_node_put(port);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
break;
}
}
/* of_phy_connect() is needed only for MAC-PHY interface */
if (!mac_phy_link)
return;
/* Allocate dummy netdev device for attaching to phy device */
gbe_dev->dummy_ndev = alloc_netdev(sizeof(gbe_dev), "dummy",
NET_NAME_UNKNOWN, ether_setup);
if (!gbe_dev->dummy_ndev) {
dev_err(dev,
"Failed to allocate dummy netdev for secondary ports, skipping phy_connect()...\n");
return;
}
priv = netdev_priv(gbe_dev->dummy_ndev);
*priv = gbe_dev;
if (slave->link_interface == SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) {
phy_mode = PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_SGMII;
slave->phy_port_t = PORT_MII;
} else if (slave->link_interface == RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) {
phy_mode = PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_RGMII;
slave->phy_port_t = PORT_MII;
} else {
phy_mode = PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_NA;
slave->phy_port_t = PORT_FIBRE;
}
for_each_sec_slave(slave, gbe_dev) {
if ((slave->link_interface != SGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) &&
(slave->link_interface != RGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY) &&
(slave->link_interface != XGMII_LINK_MAC_PHY))
continue;
slave->phy =
of_phy_connect(gbe_dev->dummy_ndev,
slave->phy_node,
gbe_adjust_link_sec_slaves,
0, phy_mode);
if (!slave->phy) {
dev_err(dev, "phy not found for slave %d\n",
slave->slave_num);
} else {
dev_dbg(dev, "phy found: id is: 0x%s\n",
phydev_name(slave->phy));
phy_start(slave->phy);
}
}
}
static void free_secondary_ports(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev)
{
struct gbe_slave *slave;
while (!list_empty(&gbe_dev->secondary_slaves)) {
slave = first_sec_slave(gbe_dev);
if (slave->phy)
phy_disconnect(slave->phy);
list_del(&slave->slave_list);
}
if (gbe_dev->dummy_ndev)
free_netdev(gbe_dev->dummy_ndev);
}
static int set_xgbe_ethss10_priv(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
struct device_node *node)
{
struct resource res;
void __iomem *regs;
int ret, i;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
ret = of_address_to_resource(node, XGBE_SS_REG_INDEX, &res);
if (ret) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Can't xlate xgbe of node(%pOFn) ss address at %d\n",
node, XGBE_SS_REG_INDEX);
return ret;
}
regs = devm_ioremap_resource(gbe_dev->dev, &res);
if (IS_ERR(regs)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "Failed to map xgbe ss register base\n");
return PTR_ERR(regs);
}
gbe_dev->ss_regs = regs;
ret = of_address_to_resource(node, XGBE_SM_REG_INDEX, &res);
if (ret) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Can't xlate xgbe of node(%pOFn) sm address at %d\n",
node, XGBE_SM_REG_INDEX);
return ret;
}
regs = devm_ioremap_resource(gbe_dev->dev, &res);
if (IS_ERR(regs)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "Failed to map xgbe sm register base\n");
return PTR_ERR(regs);
}
gbe_dev->switch_regs = regs;
ret = of_address_to_resource(node, XGBE_SERDES_REG_INDEX, &res);
if (ret) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Can't xlate xgbe serdes of node(%pOFn) address at %d\n",
node, XGBE_SERDES_REG_INDEX);
return ret;
}
regs = devm_ioremap_resource(gbe_dev->dev, &res);
if (IS_ERR(regs)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "Failed to map xgbe serdes register base\n");
return PTR_ERR(regs);
}
gbe_dev->xgbe_serdes_regs = regs;
gbe_dev->num_stats_mods = gbe_dev->max_num_ports;
gbe_dev->et_stats = xgbe10_et_stats;
gbe_dev->num_et_stats = ARRAY_SIZE(xgbe10_et_stats);
treewide: devm_kzalloc() -> devm_kcalloc() The devm_kzalloc() function has a 2-factor argument form, devm_kcalloc(). This patch replaces cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) with: devm_kcalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) as well as handling cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b * c, gfp) with: devm_kzalloc(handle, array3_size(a, b, c), gfp) as it's slightly less ugly than: devm_kcalloc(handle, array_size(a, b), c, gfp) This does, however, attempt to ignore constant size factors like: devm_kzalloc(handle, 4 * 1024, gfp) though any constants defined via macros get caught up in the conversion. Any factors with a sizeof() of "unsigned char", "char", and "u8" were dropped, since they're redundant. Some manual whitespace fixes were needed in this patch, as Coccinelle really liked to write "=devm_kcalloc..." instead of "= devm_kcalloc...". The Coccinelle script used for this was: // Fix redundant parens around sizeof(). @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING, E; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(TYPE)) * E + sizeof(TYPE) * E , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(THING)) * E + sizeof(THING) * E , ...) ) // Drop single-byte sizes and redundant parens. @@ expression HANDLE; expression COUNT; typedef u8; typedef __u8; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) ) // 2-factor product with sizeof(type/expression) and identifier or constant. @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING; identifier COUNT_ID; constant COUNT_CONST; @@ ( - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) ) // 2-factor product, only identifiers. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier SIZE, COUNT; @@ - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - SIZE * COUNT + COUNT, SIZE , ...) // 3-factor product with 1 sizeof(type) or sizeof(expression), with // redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING; identifier STRIDE, COUNT; type TYPE; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product with 2 sizeof(variable), with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING1, THING2; identifier COUNT; type TYPE1, TYPE2; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(TYPE2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product, only identifiers, with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier STRIDE, SIZE, COUNT; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) ) // Any remaining multi-factor products, first at least 3-factor products, // when they're not all constants... @@ expression HANDLE; expression E1, E2, E3; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * (E3) + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - E1 * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) ) // And then all remaining 2 factors products when they're not all constants, // keeping sizeof() as the second factor argument. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING, E1, E2; type TYPE; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(THING) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(TYPE) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2, ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * E2 + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * E2 + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - E1 * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) ) Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2018-06-12 15:07:58 -06:00
gbe_dev->hw_stats = devm_kcalloc(gbe_dev->dev,
gbe_dev->num_et_stats, sizeof(u64),
GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_dev->hw_stats) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "hw_stats memory allocation failed\n");
return -ENOMEM;
}
gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev =
treewide: devm_kzalloc() -> devm_kcalloc() The devm_kzalloc() function has a 2-factor argument form, devm_kcalloc(). This patch replaces cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) with: devm_kcalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) as well as handling cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b * c, gfp) with: devm_kzalloc(handle, array3_size(a, b, c), gfp) as it's slightly less ugly than: devm_kcalloc(handle, array_size(a, b), c, gfp) This does, however, attempt to ignore constant size factors like: devm_kzalloc(handle, 4 * 1024, gfp) though any constants defined via macros get caught up in the conversion. Any factors with a sizeof() of "unsigned char", "char", and "u8" were dropped, since they're redundant. Some manual whitespace fixes were needed in this patch, as Coccinelle really liked to write "=devm_kcalloc..." instead of "= devm_kcalloc...". The Coccinelle script used for this was: // Fix redundant parens around sizeof(). @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING, E; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(TYPE)) * E + sizeof(TYPE) * E , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(THING)) * E + sizeof(THING) * E , ...) ) // Drop single-byte sizes and redundant parens. @@ expression HANDLE; expression COUNT; typedef u8; typedef __u8; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) ) // 2-factor product with sizeof(type/expression) and identifier or constant. @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING; identifier COUNT_ID; constant COUNT_CONST; @@ ( - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) ) // 2-factor product, only identifiers. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier SIZE, COUNT; @@ - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - SIZE * COUNT + COUNT, SIZE , ...) // 3-factor product with 1 sizeof(type) or sizeof(expression), with // redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING; identifier STRIDE, COUNT; type TYPE; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product with 2 sizeof(variable), with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING1, THING2; identifier COUNT; type TYPE1, TYPE2; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(TYPE2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product, only identifiers, with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier STRIDE, SIZE, COUNT; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) ) // Any remaining multi-factor products, first at least 3-factor products, // when they're not all constants... @@ expression HANDLE; expression E1, E2, E3; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * (E3) + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - E1 * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) ) // And then all remaining 2 factors products when they're not all constants, // keeping sizeof() as the second factor argument. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING, E1, E2; type TYPE; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(THING) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(TYPE) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2, ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * E2 + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * E2 + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - E1 * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) ) Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2018-06-12 15:07:58 -06:00
devm_kcalloc(gbe_dev->dev,
gbe_dev->num_et_stats, sizeof(u32),
GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"hw_stats_prev memory allocation failed\n");
return -ENOMEM;
}
gbe_dev->ss_version = XGBE_SS_VERSION_10;
gbe_dev->sgmii_port_regs = gbe_dev->ss_regs +
XGBE10_SGMII_MODULE_OFFSET;
gbe_dev->host_port_regs = gbe_dev->ss_regs + XGBE10_HOST_PORT_OFFSET;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
for (i = 0; i < gbe_dev->max_num_ports; i++)
gbe_dev->hw_stats_regs[i] = gbe_dev->switch_regs +
XGBE10_HW_STATS_OFFSET + (GBE_HW_STATS_REG_MAP_SZ * i);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
gbe_dev->ale_reg = gbe_dev->switch_regs + XGBE10_ALE_OFFSET;
gbe_dev->cpts_reg = gbe_dev->switch_regs + XGBE10_CPTS_OFFSET;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
gbe_dev->ale_ports = gbe_dev->max_num_ports;
gbe_dev->host_port = XGBE10_HOST_PORT_NUM;
gbe_dev->ale_entries = XGBE10_NUM_ALE_ENTRIES;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
gbe_dev->stats_en_mask = (1 << (gbe_dev->max_num_ports)) - 1;
/* Subsystem registers */
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, ss_regs, id_ver);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, ss_regs, control);
/* Switch module registers */
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, id_ver);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, control);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, ptype);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, stat_port_en);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, flow_control);
/* Host port registers */
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, port_vlan);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, tx_pri_map);
XGBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, rx_maxlen);
return 0;
}
static int get_gbe_resource_version(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
struct device_node *node)
{
struct resource res;
void __iomem *regs;
int ret;
ret = of_address_to_resource(node, GBE_SS_REG_INDEX, &res);
if (ret) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Can't translate of node(%pOFn) of gbe ss address at %d\n",
node, GBE_SS_REG_INDEX);
return ret;
}
regs = devm_ioremap_resource(gbe_dev->dev, &res);
if (IS_ERR(regs)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "Failed to map gbe register base\n");
return PTR_ERR(regs);
}
gbe_dev->ss_regs = regs;
gbe_dev->ss_version = readl(gbe_dev->ss_regs);
return 0;
}
static int set_gbe_ethss14_priv(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
struct device_node *node)
{
struct resource res;
void __iomem *regs;
int i, ret;
ret = of_address_to_resource(node, GBE_SGMII34_REG_INDEX, &res);
if (ret) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Can't translate of gbe node(%pOFn) address at index %d\n",
node, GBE_SGMII34_REG_INDEX);
return ret;
}
regs = devm_ioremap_resource(gbe_dev->dev, &res);
if (IS_ERR(regs)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Failed to map gbe sgmii port34 register base\n");
return PTR_ERR(regs);
}
gbe_dev->sgmii_port34_regs = regs;
ret = of_address_to_resource(node, GBE_SM_REG_INDEX, &res);
if (ret) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Can't translate of gbe node(%pOFn) address at index %d\n",
node, GBE_SM_REG_INDEX);
return ret;
}
regs = devm_ioremap_resource(gbe_dev->dev, &res);
if (IS_ERR(regs)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Failed to map gbe switch module register base\n");
return PTR_ERR(regs);
}
gbe_dev->switch_regs = regs;
gbe_dev->num_stats_mods = gbe_dev->max_num_slaves;
gbe_dev->et_stats = gbe13_et_stats;
gbe_dev->num_et_stats = ARRAY_SIZE(gbe13_et_stats);
treewide: devm_kzalloc() -> devm_kcalloc() The devm_kzalloc() function has a 2-factor argument form, devm_kcalloc(). This patch replaces cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) with: devm_kcalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) as well as handling cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b * c, gfp) with: devm_kzalloc(handle, array3_size(a, b, c), gfp) as it's slightly less ugly than: devm_kcalloc(handle, array_size(a, b), c, gfp) This does, however, attempt to ignore constant size factors like: devm_kzalloc(handle, 4 * 1024, gfp) though any constants defined via macros get caught up in the conversion. Any factors with a sizeof() of "unsigned char", "char", and "u8" were dropped, since they're redundant. Some manual whitespace fixes were needed in this patch, as Coccinelle really liked to write "=devm_kcalloc..." instead of "= devm_kcalloc...". The Coccinelle script used for this was: // Fix redundant parens around sizeof(). @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING, E; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(TYPE)) * E + sizeof(TYPE) * E , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(THING)) * E + sizeof(THING) * E , ...) ) // Drop single-byte sizes and redundant parens. @@ expression HANDLE; expression COUNT; typedef u8; typedef __u8; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) ) // 2-factor product with sizeof(type/expression) and identifier or constant. @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING; identifier COUNT_ID; constant COUNT_CONST; @@ ( - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) ) // 2-factor product, only identifiers. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier SIZE, COUNT; @@ - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - SIZE * COUNT + COUNT, SIZE , ...) // 3-factor product with 1 sizeof(type) or sizeof(expression), with // redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING; identifier STRIDE, COUNT; type TYPE; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product with 2 sizeof(variable), with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING1, THING2; identifier COUNT; type TYPE1, TYPE2; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(TYPE2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product, only identifiers, with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier STRIDE, SIZE, COUNT; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) ) // Any remaining multi-factor products, first at least 3-factor products, // when they're not all constants... @@ expression HANDLE; expression E1, E2, E3; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * (E3) + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - E1 * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) ) // And then all remaining 2 factors products when they're not all constants, // keeping sizeof() as the second factor argument. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING, E1, E2; type TYPE; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(THING) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(TYPE) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2, ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * E2 + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * E2 + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - E1 * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) ) Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2018-06-12 15:07:58 -06:00
gbe_dev->hw_stats = devm_kcalloc(gbe_dev->dev,
gbe_dev->num_et_stats, sizeof(u64),
GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_dev->hw_stats) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "hw_stats memory allocation failed\n");
return -ENOMEM;
}
gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev =
treewide: devm_kzalloc() -> devm_kcalloc() The devm_kzalloc() function has a 2-factor argument form, devm_kcalloc(). This patch replaces cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) with: devm_kcalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) as well as handling cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b * c, gfp) with: devm_kzalloc(handle, array3_size(a, b, c), gfp) as it's slightly less ugly than: devm_kcalloc(handle, array_size(a, b), c, gfp) This does, however, attempt to ignore constant size factors like: devm_kzalloc(handle, 4 * 1024, gfp) though any constants defined via macros get caught up in the conversion. Any factors with a sizeof() of "unsigned char", "char", and "u8" were dropped, since they're redundant. Some manual whitespace fixes were needed in this patch, as Coccinelle really liked to write "=devm_kcalloc..." instead of "= devm_kcalloc...". The Coccinelle script used for this was: // Fix redundant parens around sizeof(). @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING, E; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(TYPE)) * E + sizeof(TYPE) * E , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(THING)) * E + sizeof(THING) * E , ...) ) // Drop single-byte sizes and redundant parens. @@ expression HANDLE; expression COUNT; typedef u8; typedef __u8; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) ) // 2-factor product with sizeof(type/expression) and identifier or constant. @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING; identifier COUNT_ID; constant COUNT_CONST; @@ ( - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) ) // 2-factor product, only identifiers. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier SIZE, COUNT; @@ - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - SIZE * COUNT + COUNT, SIZE , ...) // 3-factor product with 1 sizeof(type) or sizeof(expression), with // redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING; identifier STRIDE, COUNT; type TYPE; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product with 2 sizeof(variable), with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING1, THING2; identifier COUNT; type TYPE1, TYPE2; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(TYPE2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product, only identifiers, with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier STRIDE, SIZE, COUNT; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) ) // Any remaining multi-factor products, first at least 3-factor products, // when they're not all constants... @@ expression HANDLE; expression E1, E2, E3; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * (E3) + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - E1 * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) ) // And then all remaining 2 factors products when they're not all constants, // keeping sizeof() as the second factor argument. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING, E1, E2; type TYPE; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(THING) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(TYPE) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2, ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * E2 + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * E2 + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - E1 * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) ) Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2018-06-12 15:07:58 -06:00
devm_kcalloc(gbe_dev->dev,
gbe_dev->num_et_stats, sizeof(u32),
GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"hw_stats_prev memory allocation failed\n");
return -ENOMEM;
}
gbe_dev->sgmii_port_regs = gbe_dev->ss_regs + GBE13_SGMII_MODULE_OFFSET;
gbe_dev->host_port_regs = gbe_dev->switch_regs + GBE13_HOST_PORT_OFFSET;
/* K2HK has only 2 hw stats modules visible at a time, so
* module 0 & 2 points to one base and
* module 1 & 3 points to the other base
*/
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
for (i = 0; i < gbe_dev->max_num_slaves; i++) {
gbe_dev->hw_stats_regs[i] =
gbe_dev->switch_regs + GBE13_HW_STATS_OFFSET +
(GBE_HW_STATS_REG_MAP_SZ * (i & 0x1));
}
gbe_dev->cpts_reg = gbe_dev->switch_regs + GBE13_CPTS_OFFSET;
gbe_dev->ale_reg = gbe_dev->switch_regs + GBE13_ALE_OFFSET;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
gbe_dev->ale_ports = gbe_dev->max_num_ports;
gbe_dev->host_port = GBE13_HOST_PORT_NUM;
gbe_dev->ale_entries = GBE13_NUM_ALE_ENTRIES;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
gbe_dev->stats_en_mask = GBE13_REG_VAL_STAT_ENABLE_ALL;
/* Subsystem registers */
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, ss_regs, id_ver);
/* Switch module registers */
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, id_ver);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, control);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, soft_reset);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, stat_port_en);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, ptype);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, flow_control);
/* Host port registers */
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, port_vlan);
GBE_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, rx_maxlen);
return 0;
}
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
static int set_gbenu_ethss_priv(struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev,
struct device_node *node)
{
struct resource res;
void __iomem *regs;
int i, ret;
gbe_dev->num_stats_mods = gbe_dev->max_num_ports;
gbe_dev->et_stats = gbenu_et_stats;
if (IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev))
gbe_dev->num_et_stats = GBENU_ET_STATS_HOST_SIZE +
(gbe_dev->max_num_slaves * GBENU_ET_STATS_PORT_SIZE);
else
gbe_dev->num_et_stats = GBENU_ET_STATS_HOST_SIZE +
GBENU_ET_STATS_PORT_SIZE;
treewide: devm_kzalloc() -> devm_kcalloc() The devm_kzalloc() function has a 2-factor argument form, devm_kcalloc(). This patch replaces cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) with: devm_kcalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) as well as handling cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b * c, gfp) with: devm_kzalloc(handle, array3_size(a, b, c), gfp) as it's slightly less ugly than: devm_kcalloc(handle, array_size(a, b), c, gfp) This does, however, attempt to ignore constant size factors like: devm_kzalloc(handle, 4 * 1024, gfp) though any constants defined via macros get caught up in the conversion. Any factors with a sizeof() of "unsigned char", "char", and "u8" were dropped, since they're redundant. Some manual whitespace fixes were needed in this patch, as Coccinelle really liked to write "=devm_kcalloc..." instead of "= devm_kcalloc...". The Coccinelle script used for this was: // Fix redundant parens around sizeof(). @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING, E; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(TYPE)) * E + sizeof(TYPE) * E , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(THING)) * E + sizeof(THING) * E , ...) ) // Drop single-byte sizes and redundant parens. @@ expression HANDLE; expression COUNT; typedef u8; typedef __u8; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) ) // 2-factor product with sizeof(type/expression) and identifier or constant. @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING; identifier COUNT_ID; constant COUNT_CONST; @@ ( - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) ) // 2-factor product, only identifiers. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier SIZE, COUNT; @@ - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - SIZE * COUNT + COUNT, SIZE , ...) // 3-factor product with 1 sizeof(type) or sizeof(expression), with // redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING; identifier STRIDE, COUNT; type TYPE; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product with 2 sizeof(variable), with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING1, THING2; identifier COUNT; type TYPE1, TYPE2; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(TYPE2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product, only identifiers, with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier STRIDE, SIZE, COUNT; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) ) // Any remaining multi-factor products, first at least 3-factor products, // when they're not all constants... @@ expression HANDLE; expression E1, E2, E3; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * (E3) + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - E1 * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) ) // And then all remaining 2 factors products when they're not all constants, // keeping sizeof() as the second factor argument. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING, E1, E2; type TYPE; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(THING) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(TYPE) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2, ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * E2 + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * E2 + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - E1 * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) ) Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2018-06-12 15:07:58 -06:00
gbe_dev->hw_stats = devm_kcalloc(gbe_dev->dev,
gbe_dev->num_et_stats, sizeof(u64),
GFP_KERNEL);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
if (!gbe_dev->hw_stats) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "hw_stats memory allocation failed\n");
return -ENOMEM;
}
gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev =
treewide: devm_kzalloc() -> devm_kcalloc() The devm_kzalloc() function has a 2-factor argument form, devm_kcalloc(). This patch replaces cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) with: devm_kcalloc(handle, a * b, gfp) as well as handling cases of: devm_kzalloc(handle, a * b * c, gfp) with: devm_kzalloc(handle, array3_size(a, b, c), gfp) as it's slightly less ugly than: devm_kcalloc(handle, array_size(a, b), c, gfp) This does, however, attempt to ignore constant size factors like: devm_kzalloc(handle, 4 * 1024, gfp) though any constants defined via macros get caught up in the conversion. Any factors with a sizeof() of "unsigned char", "char", and "u8" were dropped, since they're redundant. Some manual whitespace fixes were needed in this patch, as Coccinelle really liked to write "=devm_kcalloc..." instead of "= devm_kcalloc...". The Coccinelle script used for this was: // Fix redundant parens around sizeof(). @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING, E; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(TYPE)) * E + sizeof(TYPE) * E , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (sizeof(THING)) * E + sizeof(THING) * E , ...) ) // Drop single-byte sizes and redundant parens. @@ expression HANDLE; expression COUNT; typedef u8; typedef __u8; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * (COUNT) + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(__u8) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(unsigned char) * COUNT + COUNT , ...) ) // 2-factor product with sizeof(type/expression) and identifier or constant. @@ expression HANDLE; type TYPE; expression THING; identifier COUNT_ID; constant COUNT_CONST; @@ ( - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_ID) + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_ID + COUNT_ID, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT_CONST) + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT_CONST + COUNT_CONST, sizeof(THING) , ...) ) // 2-factor product, only identifiers. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier SIZE, COUNT; @@ - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - SIZE * COUNT + COUNT, SIZE , ...) // 3-factor product with 1 sizeof(type) or sizeof(expression), with // redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING; identifier STRIDE, COUNT; type TYPE; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(TYPE)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (COUNT) * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * (STRIDE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * COUNT * STRIDE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, sizeof(THING)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product with 2 sizeof(variable), with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING1, THING2; identifier COUNT; type TYPE1, TYPE2; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(TYPE2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(TYPE2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(THING1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(THING1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * COUNT + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE1) * sizeof(THING2) * (COUNT) + array3_size(COUNT, sizeof(TYPE1), sizeof(THING2)) , ...) ) // 3-factor product, only identifiers, with redundant parens removed. @@ expression HANDLE; identifier STRIDE, SIZE, COUNT; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * STRIDE * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (COUNT) * (STRIDE) * (SIZE) + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - COUNT * STRIDE * SIZE + array3_size(COUNT, STRIDE, SIZE) , ...) ) // Any remaining multi-factor products, first at least 3-factor products, // when they're not all constants... @@ expression HANDLE; expression E1, E2, E3; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) * (E3) + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, - E1 * E2 * E3 + array3_size(E1, E2, E3) , ...) ) // And then all remaining 2 factors products when they're not all constants, // keeping sizeof() as the second factor argument. @@ expression HANDLE; expression THING, E1, E2; type TYPE; constant C1, C2, C3; @@ ( devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(THING) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, sizeof(TYPE) * C2, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2 * C3, ...) | devm_kzalloc(HANDLE, C1 * C2, ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(TYPE) * E2 + E2, sizeof(TYPE) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * (E2) + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - sizeof(THING) * E2 + E2, sizeof(THING) , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - (E1) * (E2) + E1, E2 , ...) | - devm_kzalloc + devm_kcalloc (HANDLE, - E1 * E2 + E1, E2 , ...) ) Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2018-06-12 15:07:58 -06:00
devm_kcalloc(gbe_dev->dev,
gbe_dev->num_et_stats, sizeof(u32),
GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_dev->hw_stats_prev) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"hw_stats_prev memory allocation failed\n");
return -ENOMEM;
}
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
ret = of_address_to_resource(node, GBENU_SM_REG_INDEX, &res);
if (ret) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Can't translate of gbenu node(%pOFn) addr at index %d\n",
node, GBENU_SM_REG_INDEX);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
return ret;
}
regs = devm_ioremap_resource(gbe_dev->dev, &res);
if (IS_ERR(regs)) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev,
"Failed to map gbenu switch module register base\n");
return PTR_ERR(regs);
}
gbe_dev->switch_regs = regs;
if (!IS_SS_ID_2U(gbe_dev))
gbe_dev->sgmii_port_regs =
gbe_dev->ss_regs + GBENU_SGMII_MODULE_OFFSET;
/* Although sgmii modules are mem mapped to one contiguous
* region on GBENU devices, setting sgmii_port34_regs allows
* consistent code when accessing sgmii api
*/
gbe_dev->sgmii_port34_regs = gbe_dev->sgmii_port_regs +
(2 * GBENU_SGMII_MODULE_SIZE);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
gbe_dev->host_port_regs = gbe_dev->switch_regs + GBENU_HOST_PORT_OFFSET;
for (i = 0; i < (gbe_dev->max_num_ports); i++)
gbe_dev->hw_stats_regs[i] = gbe_dev->switch_regs +
GBENU_HW_STATS_OFFSET + (GBENU_HW_STATS_REG_MAP_SZ * i);
gbe_dev->cpts_reg = gbe_dev->switch_regs + GBENU_CPTS_OFFSET;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
gbe_dev->ale_reg = gbe_dev->switch_regs + GBENU_ALE_OFFSET;
gbe_dev->ale_ports = gbe_dev->max_num_ports;
gbe_dev->host_port = GBENU_HOST_PORT_NUM;
gbe_dev->stats_en_mask = (1 << (gbe_dev->max_num_ports)) - 1;
/* Subsystem registers */
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, ss_regs, id_ver);
/* ok to set for MU, but used by 2U only */
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, ss_regs, rgmii_status);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
/* Switch module registers */
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, id_ver);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, control);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, stat_port_en);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, switch_regs, ptype);
/* Host port registers */
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, port_vlan);
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, rx_maxlen);
/* For NU only. 2U does not need tx_pri_map.
* NU cppi port 0 tx pkt streaming interface has (n-1)*8 egress threads
* while 2U has only 1 such thread
*/
GBENU_SET_REG_OFS(gbe_dev, host_port_regs, tx_pri_map);
return 0;
}
static int gbe_probe(struct netcp_device *netcp_device, struct device *dev,
struct device_node *node, void **inst_priv)
{
struct device_node *interfaces, *interface, *cpts_node;
struct device_node *secondary_ports;
struct cpsw_ale_params ale_params;
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev;
u32 slave_num;
int i, ret = 0;
if (!node) {
dev_err(dev, "device tree info unavailable\n");
return -ENODEV;
}
gbe_dev = devm_kzalloc(dev, sizeof(struct gbe_priv), GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_dev)
return -ENOMEM;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
if (of_device_is_compatible(node, "ti,netcp-gbe-5") ||
of_device_is_compatible(node, "ti,netcp-gbe")) {
gbe_dev->max_num_slaves = 4;
} else if (of_device_is_compatible(node, "ti,netcp-gbe-9")) {
gbe_dev->max_num_slaves = 8;
} else if (of_device_is_compatible(node, "ti,netcp-gbe-2")) {
gbe_dev->max_num_slaves = 1;
gbe_module.set_rx_mode = gbe_set_rx_mode;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
} else if (of_device_is_compatible(node, "ti,netcp-xgbe")) {
gbe_dev->max_num_slaves = 2;
} else {
dev_err(dev, "device tree node for unknown device\n");
return -EINVAL;
}
gbe_dev->max_num_ports = gbe_dev->max_num_slaves + 1;
gbe_dev->dev = dev;
gbe_dev->netcp_device = netcp_device;
gbe_dev->rx_packet_max = NETCP_MAX_FRAME_SIZE;
/* init the hw stats lock */
spin_lock_init(&gbe_dev->hw_stats_lock);
if (of_find_property(node, "enable-ale", NULL)) {
gbe_dev->enable_ale = true;
dev_info(dev, "ALE enabled\n");
} else {
gbe_dev->enable_ale = false;
dev_dbg(dev, "ALE bypass enabled*\n");
}
ret = of_property_read_u32(node, "tx-queue",
&gbe_dev->tx_queue_id);
if (ret < 0) {
dev_err(dev, "missing tx_queue parameter\n");
gbe_dev->tx_queue_id = GBE_TX_QUEUE;
}
ret = of_property_read_string(node, "tx-channel",
&gbe_dev->dma_chan_name);
if (ret < 0) {
dev_err(dev, "missing \"tx-channel\" parameter\n");
return -EINVAL;
}
if (of_node_name_eq(node, "gbe")) {
ret = get_gbe_resource_version(gbe_dev, node);
if (ret)
return ret;
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
dev_dbg(dev, "ss_version: 0x%08x\n", gbe_dev->ss_version);
if (IS_SS_ID_VER_14(gbe_dev))
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
ret = set_gbe_ethss14_priv(gbe_dev, node);
else if (IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev))
ret = set_gbenu_ethss_priv(gbe_dev, node);
else
ret = -ENODEV;
} else if (of_node_name_eq(node, "xgbe")) {
ret = set_xgbe_ethss10_priv(gbe_dev, node);
if (ret)
return ret;
ret = netcp_xgbe_serdes_init(gbe_dev->xgbe_serdes_regs,
gbe_dev->ss_regs);
} else {
dev_err(dev, "unknown GBE node(%pOFn)\n", node);
ret = -ENODEV;
}
if (ret)
return ret;
interfaces = of_get_child_by_name(node, "interfaces");
if (!interfaces)
dev_err(dev, "could not find interfaces\n");
ret = netcp_txpipe_init(&gbe_dev->tx_pipe, netcp_device,
gbe_dev->dma_chan_name, gbe_dev->tx_queue_id);
if (ret) {
of_node_put(interfaces);
return ret;
}
ret = netcp_txpipe_open(&gbe_dev->tx_pipe);
if (ret) {
of_node_put(interfaces);
return ret;
}
/* Create network interfaces */
INIT_LIST_HEAD(&gbe_dev->gbe_intf_head);
for_each_child_of_node(interfaces, interface) {
ret = of_property_read_u32(interface, "slave-port", &slave_num);
if (ret) {
dev_err(dev, "missing slave-port parameter, skipping interface configuration for %pOFn\n",
interface);
continue;
}
gbe_dev->num_slaves++;
if (gbe_dev->num_slaves >= gbe_dev->max_num_slaves) {
of_node_put(interface);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
break;
}
}
of_node_put(interfaces);
if (!gbe_dev->num_slaves)
dev_warn(dev, "No network interface configured\n");
/* Initialize Secondary slave ports */
secondary_ports = of_get_child_by_name(node, "secondary-slave-ports");
INIT_LIST_HEAD(&gbe_dev->secondary_slaves);
net: netcp: ethss: enhancement to support NetCP 1.5 ethss NetCP 1.5 available on newer K2 SoCs such as K2E and K2L introduced 3 variants of the ethss subsystem, 9 port, 5 port and 2 port. These have one host port towards the CPU and N external slave ports. To customize the driver for these new ethss sub systems, multiple compatibility strings are introduced. Currently some of parameters that are different on different variants such as number of ALE ports, stats modules and number of ports are defined through constants. These are now changed to variables in gbe_priv data that get set based on the compatibility string. This is required as there are no hardware identification registers available to distinguish among the variants of NetCP 1.5 ethss. However there is identification register available to differentiate between NetCP 1.4 vs NetCP 1.5 and the same is made use of in the code to differentiate them. For more reading on the details of this peripheral, please refer to the User Guide available at http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruhz3 Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com> Signed-off-by: WingMan Kwok <w-kwok2@ti.com> CC: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net> CC: Mugunthan V N <mugunthanvnm@ti.com> CC: "Lad, Prabhakar" <prabhakar.csengg@gmail.com> CC: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com> CC: Christoph Jaeger <cj@linux.com> CC: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com> CC: Markus Pargmann <mpa@pengutronix.de> CC: Kumar Gala <galak@codeaurora.org> CC: Ian Campbell <ijc+devicetree@hellion.org.uk> CC: Mark Rutland <mark.rutland@arm.com> CC: Pawel Moll <pawel.moll@arm.com> CC: Rob Herring <robh+dt@kernel.org> Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-03-20 14:11:25 -06:00
if (secondary_ports && (gbe_dev->num_slaves < gbe_dev->max_num_slaves))
init_secondary_ports(gbe_dev, secondary_ports);
of_node_put(secondary_ports);
if (!gbe_dev->num_slaves) {
dev_err(dev,
"No network interface or secondary ports configured\n");
ret = -ENODEV;
goto free_sec_ports;
}
memset(&ale_params, 0, sizeof(ale_params));
ale_params.dev = gbe_dev->dev;
ale_params.ale_regs = gbe_dev->ale_reg;
ale_params.ale_ageout = GBE_DEFAULT_ALE_AGEOUT;
ale_params.ale_entries = gbe_dev->ale_entries;
ale_params.ale_ports = gbe_dev->ale_ports;
if (IS_SS_ID_MU(gbe_dev)) {
ale_params.major_ver_mask = 0x7;
ale_params.nu_switch_ale = true;
}
gbe_dev->ale = cpsw_ale_create(&ale_params);
if (!gbe_dev->ale) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "error initializing ale engine\n");
ret = -ENODEV;
goto free_sec_ports;
} else {
dev_dbg(gbe_dev->dev, "Created a gbe ale engine\n");
}
cpts_node = of_get_child_by_name(node, "cpts");
if (!cpts_node)
cpts_node = of_node_get(node);
gbe_dev->cpts = cpts_create(gbe_dev->dev, gbe_dev->cpts_reg, cpts_node);
of_node_put(cpts_node);
if (IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_TI_CPTS) && IS_ERR(gbe_dev->cpts)) {
ret = PTR_ERR(gbe_dev->cpts);
goto free_sec_ports;
}
/* initialize host port */
gbe_init_host_port(gbe_dev);
spin_lock_bh(&gbe_dev->hw_stats_lock);
for (i = 0; i < gbe_dev->num_stats_mods; i++) {
if (IS_SS_ID_VER_14(gbe_dev))
gbe_reset_mod_stats_ver14(gbe_dev, i);
else
gbe_reset_mod_stats(gbe_dev, i);
}
spin_unlock_bh(&gbe_dev->hw_stats_lock);
treewide: setup_timer() -> timer_setup() This converts all remaining cases of the old setup_timer() API into using timer_setup(), where the callback argument is the structure already holding the struct timer_list. These should have no behavioral changes, since they just change which pointer is passed into the callback with the same available pointers after conversion. It handles the following examples, in addition to some other variations. Casting from unsigned long: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { struct something *ptr = (struct something *)data; ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, ptr); and forced object casts: void my_callback(struct something *ptr) { ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, (unsigned long)ptr); become: void my_callback(struct timer_list *t) { struct something *ptr = from_timer(ptr, t, my_timer); ... } ... timer_setup(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); Direct function assignments: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { struct something *ptr = (struct something *)data; ... } ... ptr->my_timer.function = my_callback; have a temporary cast added, along with converting the args: void my_callback(struct timer_list *t) { struct something *ptr = from_timer(ptr, t, my_timer); ... } ... ptr->my_timer.function = (TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)my_callback; And finally, callbacks without a data assignment: void my_callback(unsigned long data) { ... } ... setup_timer(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); have their argument renamed to verify they're unused during conversion: void my_callback(struct timer_list *unused) { ... } ... timer_setup(&ptr->my_timer, my_callback, 0); The conversion is done with the following Coccinelle script: spatch --very-quiet --all-includes --include-headers \ -I ./arch/x86/include -I ./arch/x86/include/generated \ -I ./include -I ./arch/x86/include/uapi \ -I ./arch/x86/include/generated/uapi -I ./include/uapi \ -I ./include/generated/uapi --include ./include/linux/kconfig.h \ --dir . \ --cocci-file ~/src/data/timer_setup.cocci @fix_address_of@ expression e; @@ setup_timer( -&(e) +&e , ...) // Update any raw setup_timer() usages that have a NULL callback, but // would otherwise match change_timer_function_usage, since the latter // will update all function assignments done in the face of a NULL // function initialization in setup_timer(). @change_timer_function_usage_NULL@ expression _E; identifier _timer; type _cast_data; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, NULL, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, NULL, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, NULL, &_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, NULL, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, NULL, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, NULL, 0); ) @change_timer_function_usage@ expression _E; identifier _timer; struct timer_list _stl; identifier _callback; type _cast_func, _cast_data; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, &_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, _E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, &_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, (_cast_func)&_callback, (_cast_data)&_E); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | _E->_timer@_stl.function = _callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = &_callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)_callback; | _E->_timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)&_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = _callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = &_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)_callback; | _E._timer@_stl.function = (_cast_func)&_callback; ) // callback(unsigned long arg) @change_callback_handle_cast depends on change_timer_function_usage@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; type _handletype; identifier _handle; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *t ) { ( ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle = -(_handletype *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle = -(void *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle; ... when != _handle _handle = -(_handletype *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg | ... when != _origarg _handletype *_handle; ... when != _handle _handle = -(void *)_origarg; +from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... when != _origarg ) } // callback(unsigned long arg) without existing variable @change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; type _handletype; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *t ) { + _handletype *_origarg = from_timer(_origarg, t, _timer); + ... when != _origarg - (_handletype *)_origarg + _origarg ... when != _origarg } // Avoid already converted callbacks. @match_callback_converted depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier t; @@ void _callback(struct timer_list *t) { ... } // callback(struct something *handle) @change_callback_handle_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && !match_callback_converted && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _handletype; identifier _handle; @@ void _callback( -_handletype *_handle +struct timer_list *t ) { + _handletype *_handle = from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); ... } // If change_callback_handle_arg ran on an empty function, remove // the added handler. @unchange_callback_handle_arg depends on change_timer_function_usage && change_callback_handle_arg@ identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; type _handletype; identifier _handle; identifier t; @@ void _callback(struct timer_list *t) { - _handletype *_handle = from_timer(_handle, t, _timer); } // We only want to refactor the setup_timer() data argument if we've found // the matching callback. This undoes changes in change_timer_function_usage. @unchange_timer_function_usage depends on change_timer_function_usage && !change_callback_handle_cast && !change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg && !change_callback_handle_arg@ expression change_timer_function_usage._E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type change_timer_function_usage._cast_data; @@ ( -timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); +setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, (_cast_data)_E); | -timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); +setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, (_cast_data)&_E); ) // If we fixed a callback from a .function assignment, fix the // assignment cast now. @change_timer_function_assignment depends on change_timer_function_usage && (change_callback_handle_cast || change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg || change_callback_handle_arg)@ expression change_timer_function_usage._E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type _cast_func; typedef TIMER_FUNC_TYPE; @@ ( _E->_timer.function = -_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -(_cast_func)_callback; +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E->_timer.function = -(_cast_func)&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -&_callback; +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -(_cast_func)_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; | _E._timer.function = -(_cast_func)&_callback +(TIMER_FUNC_TYPE)_callback ; ) // Sometimes timer functions are called directly. Replace matched args. @change_timer_function_calls depends on change_timer_function_usage && (change_callback_handle_cast || change_callback_handle_cast_no_arg || change_callback_handle_arg)@ expression _E; identifier change_timer_function_usage._timer; identifier change_timer_function_usage._callback; type _cast_data; @@ _callback( ( -(_cast_data)_E +&_E->_timer | -(_cast_data)&_E +&_E._timer | -_E +&_E->_timer ) ) // If a timer has been configured without a data argument, it can be // converted without regard to the callback argument, since it is unused. @match_timer_function_unused_data@ expression _E; identifier _timer; identifier _callback; @@ ( -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_E->_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_E._timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_E._timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(&_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(&_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0L); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); | -setup_timer(_timer, _callback, 0UL); +timer_setup(_timer, _callback, 0); ) @change_callback_unused_data depends on match_timer_function_unused_data@ identifier match_timer_function_unused_data._callback; type _origtype; identifier _origarg; @@ void _callback( -_origtype _origarg +struct timer_list *unused ) { ... when != _origarg } Signed-off-by: Kees Cook <keescook@chromium.org>
2017-10-16 15:43:17 -06:00
timer_setup(&gbe_dev->timer, netcp_ethss_timer, 0);
gbe_dev->timer.expires = jiffies + GBE_TIMER_INTERVAL;
add_timer(&gbe_dev->timer);
*inst_priv = gbe_dev;
return 0;
free_sec_ports:
free_secondary_ports(gbe_dev);
return ret;
}
static int gbe_attach(void *inst_priv, struct net_device *ndev,
struct device_node *node, void **intf_priv)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = inst_priv;
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf;
int ret;
if (!node) {
dev_err(gbe_dev->dev, "interface node not available\n");
return -ENODEV;
}
gbe_intf = devm_kzalloc(gbe_dev->dev, sizeof(*gbe_intf), GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_intf)
return -ENOMEM;
gbe_intf->ndev = ndev;
gbe_intf->dev = gbe_dev->dev;
gbe_intf->gbe_dev = gbe_dev;
gbe_intf->slave = devm_kzalloc(gbe_dev->dev,
sizeof(*gbe_intf->slave),
GFP_KERNEL);
if (!gbe_intf->slave) {
ret = -ENOMEM;
goto fail;
}
if (init_slave(gbe_dev, gbe_intf->slave, node)) {
ret = -ENODEV;
goto fail;
}
gbe_intf->tx_pipe = gbe_dev->tx_pipe;
ndev->ethtool_ops = &keystone_ethtool_ops;
list_add_tail(&gbe_intf->gbe_intf_list, &gbe_dev->gbe_intf_head);
*intf_priv = gbe_intf;
return 0;
fail:
if (gbe_intf->slave)
devm_kfree(gbe_dev->dev, gbe_intf->slave);
if (gbe_intf)
devm_kfree(gbe_dev->dev, gbe_intf);
return ret;
}
static int gbe_release(void *intf_priv)
{
struct gbe_intf *gbe_intf = intf_priv;
gbe_intf->ndev->ethtool_ops = NULL;
list_del(&gbe_intf->gbe_intf_list);
devm_kfree(gbe_intf->dev, gbe_intf->slave);
devm_kfree(gbe_intf->dev, gbe_intf);
return 0;
}
static int gbe_remove(struct netcp_device *netcp_device, void *inst_priv)
{
struct gbe_priv *gbe_dev = inst_priv;
del_timer_sync(&gbe_dev->timer);
cpts_release(gbe_dev->cpts);
cpsw_ale_stop(gbe_dev->ale);
netcp_txpipe_close(&gbe_dev->tx_pipe);
free_secondary_ports(gbe_dev);
if (!list_empty(&gbe_dev->gbe_intf_head))
dev_alert(gbe_dev->dev,
"unreleased ethss interfaces present\n");
return 0;
}
static struct netcp_module gbe_module = {
.name = GBE_MODULE_NAME,
.owner = THIS_MODULE,
.primary = true,
.probe = gbe_probe,
.open = gbe_open,
.close = gbe_close,
.remove = gbe_remove,
.attach = gbe_attach,
.release = gbe_release,
.add_addr = gbe_add_addr,
.del_addr = gbe_del_addr,
.add_vid = gbe_add_vid,
.del_vid = gbe_del_vid,
.ioctl = gbe_ioctl,
};
static struct netcp_module xgbe_module = {
.name = XGBE_MODULE_NAME,
.owner = THIS_MODULE,
.primary = true,
.probe = gbe_probe,
.open = gbe_open,
.close = gbe_close,
.remove = gbe_remove,
.attach = gbe_attach,
.release = gbe_release,
.add_addr = gbe_add_addr,
.del_addr = gbe_del_addr,
.add_vid = gbe_add_vid,
.del_vid = gbe_del_vid,
.ioctl = gbe_ioctl,
};
static int __init keystone_gbe_init(void)
{
int ret;
ret = netcp_register_module(&gbe_module);
if (ret)
return ret;
ret = netcp_register_module(&xgbe_module);
if (ret)
return ret;
return 0;
}
module_init(keystone_gbe_init);
static void __exit keystone_gbe_exit(void)
{
netcp_unregister_module(&gbe_module);
netcp_unregister_module(&xgbe_module);
}
module_exit(keystone_gbe_exit);
MODULE_LICENSE("GPL v2");
MODULE_DESCRIPTION("TI NETCP ETHSS driver for Keystone SOCs");
MODULE_AUTHOR("Sandeep Nair <sandeep_n@ti.com");